blob: 3ce29ca5d14cc4cef36199b59bbfbcf3fefc1d54 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6c1b6672019-02-26 16:43:49 +01007 2019/02/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
961 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100962 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
963 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200964
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200965nbthread <number>
966 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100967 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
968 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
969 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
970 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
971 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100972 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
973 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
974 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
975 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
976 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
977 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
978 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200979
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200980pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100981 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200982 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
983 starting the process. See also "daemon".
984
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100985presetenv <name> <value>
986 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
987 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
988 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
989 and "unsetenv".
990
991resetenv [<name> ...]
992 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
993 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
994 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
995 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
996 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
997 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
998 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
999 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1000
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001001stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001002 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1003 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1004 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1005 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1006 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1007 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001008 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001009 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1010 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1011 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1012 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001013
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001014server-state-base <directory>
1015 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001016 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1017 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001018
1019server-state-file <file>
1020 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1021 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1022 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1023 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1024 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1025 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1026 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1027 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001028 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1029 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001030
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001031setenv <name> <value>
1032 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1033 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1034 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1035 and "unsetenv".
1036
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001037ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1039 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001040 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001041 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001042 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1043 information and recommendations see e.g.
1044 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1045 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1046 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1047 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001048
1049ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1050 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1051 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1052 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1053 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1054 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001055 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1056 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1057 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001058 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001060ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1061 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1062 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1063 keyword to see available options.
1064
1065 Example:
1066 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001067 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001068
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001069ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1071 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001072 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001073 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001074 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1075 information and recommendations see e.g.
1076 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1077 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1078 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1079 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1080 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001081
1082ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1084 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1085 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1086 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1087 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001088 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1089 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1090 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1091 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001092
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001093ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1094 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1095 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1096 keyword to see available options.
1097
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001098ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1100 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1101 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001102 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001103 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001104 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1105 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1106 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1107 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001108 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1109 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1110 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1111
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001112ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1113 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1114 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1115 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1116
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001117stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1118 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1119 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1120 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001121 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001122 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001123
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001124 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1125 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1126 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001127
1128stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1129 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1130 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001131 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001132
1133stats maxconn <connections>
1134 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1135 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1136
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137uid <number>
1138 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1139 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1140 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1141 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1142
1143ulimit-n <number>
1144 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1145 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1146 option.
1147
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001148unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1149 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1150
1151 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1152 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1153 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1154 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1155 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1156 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1157 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1158 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1159 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1160 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1161
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001162unsetenv [<name> ...]
1163 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1164 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1165 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1166 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1167 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1168 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1169 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1170
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171user <user name>
1172 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1173 See also "uid" and "group".
1174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001175node <name>
1176 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1177
1178 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1179 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1180 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1181 traffic.
1182
1183description <text>
1184 Add a text that describes the instance.
1185
1186 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1187 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1188 "<" and ">" characters.
1189
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100119051degrees-data-file <file path>
1191 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001192 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001193
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001194 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001195 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1196
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000119751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001198 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1199 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1200 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1201
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200120551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001206 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1207 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1208
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1210 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1211
121251degrees-cache-size <number>
1213 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1214 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1215 By default, this cache is disabled.
1216
1217 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001218 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1219
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001220wurfl-data-file <file path>
1221 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1222 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1223
1224 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1225 with USE_WURFL=1.
1226
1227wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1228 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1229 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1230 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1231
1232 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1233
1234 Valid WURFL properties are:
1235 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1236
1237 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1238 device.
1239
1240 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1241 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1242
1243 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1244 particular web request.
1245
1246 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1247 used Libwurfl API version.
1248
1249 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1250 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1251 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1252
1253 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1254 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1255
1256 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1257 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1258
1259 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1260
1261 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1262
1263 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1264 with USE_WURFL=1.
1265
1266wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1267 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1268 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1269
1270 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1271 with USE_WURFL=1.
1272
1273wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1274 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1275 thus before the chroot.
1276
1277 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1278 with USE_WURFL=1.
1279
1280wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1281 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1282 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001283 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001284 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001285 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001286 mode is enabled by default.
1287
1288 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1289 with USE_WURFL=1.
1290
1291wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1292 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1293 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1294 - "0" : no cache is used.
1295 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1296 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1297 the highest performing option.
1298
1299 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1300 with USE_WURFL=1.
1301
1302wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1303 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1304 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1305
1306 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1307 with USE_WURFL=1.
1308
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001311-----------------------
1312
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001313busy-polling
1314 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1315 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1316 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1317 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1318 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1319 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1320 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1321 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1322 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1323 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1324 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1325 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1326 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1327 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1328 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1329 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1330 "poll" pollers.
1331
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001332max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1333 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1334 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1335 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1336 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1337 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1338 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1339 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1340 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342maxconn <number>
1343 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1344 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1345 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001346 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1347 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1348 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1349 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001350 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1351 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1352 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1353 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1354 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1355 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001356
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001357maxconnrate <number>
1358 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1359 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1360 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1361 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1362 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1363 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1364 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1365 fairness.
1366
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001367maxcomprate <number>
1368 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001369 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001370 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1371 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1372 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001373 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001374 default value.
1375
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001376maxcompcpuusage <number>
1377 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1378 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1379 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1380 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1381 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1382 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1383 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1384 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1385
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001386maxpipes <number>
1387 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1388 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1389 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1390 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1391 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1392 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1393
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001394maxsessrate <number>
1395 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1396 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1397 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1398 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1399 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1400 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1401 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1402 fairness.
1403
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001404maxsslconn <number>
1405 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1406 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1407 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1408 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1409 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1410 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1411 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001412 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1413 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1414 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1415 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1416 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1417 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1418 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001419
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001420maxsslrate <number>
1421 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1422 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1423 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1424 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1425 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1426 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1427 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1428 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1429 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1430 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1431
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001432maxzlibmem <number>
1433 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1434 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1435 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001436 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1437 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1438 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1439
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001440noepoll
1441 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1442 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001443 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001444
1445nokqueue
1446 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1447 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1448 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1449
1450nopoll
1451 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1452 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001453 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001454 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001456nosplice
1457 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001458 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001459 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001460 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001461 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1462 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1463 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1464 "option splice-response".
1465
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001466nogetaddrinfo
1467 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1468 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1469
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001470noreuseport
1471 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1472 command line argument "-dR".
1473
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001474profiling.tasks { on | off }
1475 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1476 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1477 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1478 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1479 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1480 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1481 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1482 CLI.
1483
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001484spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001485 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1486 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1487 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1488 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1489 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1490 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001491
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001492ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001493 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001494 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001495 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1496 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1497 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1498 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1499 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001500 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1501 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001502 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1503 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1504 openssl configuration file uses:
1505 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1506
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001507ssl-mode-async
1508 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001509 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001510 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1511 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1512 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1513 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1514 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001515
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001516tune.buffers.limit <number>
1517 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1518 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1519 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1520 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1521 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001522 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001523 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1524 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1525 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1526 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1527 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1528 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1529 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1530 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1531 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1532
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001533tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1534 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1535 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1536 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1537 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1538
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001539tune.bufsize <number>
1540 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1541 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1542 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1543 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1544 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1545 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1546 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001547 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1548 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1549 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001550 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001551 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1552 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1553 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001554
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001555tune.chksize <number>
1556 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1557 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1558 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1559 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1560 checks whenever possible.
1561
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001562tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1563 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1564 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1565 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1566 this value. The default value is 1.
1567
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001568tune.fail-alloc
1569 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1570 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1571 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1572 gracefully.
1573
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001574tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1575 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1576 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1577 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1578 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1579 change it.
1580
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001581tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1582 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001583 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1584 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001585 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1586 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1587 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1588 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1589 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1590
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001591tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1592 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1593 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1594 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1595 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1596 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1597 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1598 recommended not to change this value.
1599
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001600tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1601 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1602 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1603 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1604 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1605 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1606 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1607 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1608
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001609tune.http.cookielen <number>
1610 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1611 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1612 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1613 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1614 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1615 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1616 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1617 to change this value.
1618
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001619tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001620 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1621 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001622 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001623 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001624 configuration directives too.
1625 The default value is 1024.
1626
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001627tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1628 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1629 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1630 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1631 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1632 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1633 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001634 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1635 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1636 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001637
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001638tune.idletimer <timeout>
1639 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1640 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1641 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1642 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1643 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1644 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001645 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001646 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1647 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1648
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001649tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1650 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1651 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1652 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1653 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1654 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1655 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1656 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1657 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1658 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1659
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001660tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1661 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001662 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001663 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1664 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001665 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001666 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1667 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1668
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001669tune.lua.maxmem
1670 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1671 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1672 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1673 memory.
1674
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001675tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1676 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001677 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1678 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001679 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001680
1681tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1682 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1683 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1684 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1685 check servers.
1686
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001687tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1688 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1689 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1690 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001691 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001692
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001693tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001694 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1695 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1696 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1697 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1698 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1699 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1700 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1701 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1702 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1703 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001704
1705tune.maxpollevents <number>
1706 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1707 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1708 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1709 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1710 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1711
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001712tune.maxrewrite <number>
1713 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1714 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1715 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1716 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1717 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1718 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1719 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1720 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1721 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1722 bufsize.
1723
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001724tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1725 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1726 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1727 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1728 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1729 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1730 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1731 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1732 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1733 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1734 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1735 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1736 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1737 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1738 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1739 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1740 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1741 setting this parameter to 0.
1742
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001743tune.pipesize <number>
1744 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1745 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1746 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1747 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1748 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1749 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1750
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001751tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1752tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1753 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1754 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1755 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1756 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001757 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001758 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1759 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1760
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001761tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001762 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001763 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1764 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1765 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1766 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1767
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001768tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1769 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1770 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1771 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1772
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001773tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1774tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1775 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1776 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1777 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1778 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001779 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001780 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1781 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1782 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1783 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1784 notifying haproxy again.
1785
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001786tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001787 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1788 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1789 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001790 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001791 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001792 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001793 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1794 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1795 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001796 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1797 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001798
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001799tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001800 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001801 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1802 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1803 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1804 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1805 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1806
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001807tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1808 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001809 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001810 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1811 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1812 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1813 being used for too long.
1814
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001815tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1816 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1817 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1818 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1819 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1820 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1821 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1822 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1823 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1824 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1825 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001826 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001827 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001828
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001829tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1830 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1831 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1832 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1833 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1834 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1835 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1836 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001837 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1838 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001839
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001840tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1841 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1842 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1843 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1844 1000 entries.
1845
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001846tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1847 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1848 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1849 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1850
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001851tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001852tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001853tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1854tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1855tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001856 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1857 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1858 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1859 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1860 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1861 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1862 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1863 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001864
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001865 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1866 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1867 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1868 all available space is consumed.
1869 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1870 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1871 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001872
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001873tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1874 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001875 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001876 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001877 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001878 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1879
1880tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1881 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1882 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001883 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1884 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018863.3. Debugging
1887--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888
1889debug
1890 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1891 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1892 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1893 system startup.
1894
1895quiet
1896 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1897 line argument "-q".
1898
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019003.4. Userlists
1901--------------
1902It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1903http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1904it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1905
1906userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001907 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001908 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1909
1910group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001911 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001912 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1913 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1914
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001915user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1916 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001917 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1918 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001919 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1920 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1921 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1922 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001923
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001924 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1925 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1926 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1927 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1928 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1929 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1930 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1931 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1932 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001933
1934 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001935 userlist L1
1936 group G1 users tiger,scott
1937 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001938
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001939 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1940 user scott insecure-password elgato
1941 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001943 userlist L2
1944 group G1
1945 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001946
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001947 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1948 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1949 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001950
1951 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001952
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001953
19543.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001955----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001956It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1957several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1958instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1959values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1960automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1961In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1962using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1963tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1964reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1965Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1966that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1967each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001968
1969peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001970 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001971 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1972
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001973bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1974 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1975 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1976
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001977disabled
1978 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1979 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1980 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1981
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001982default-bind [param*]
1983 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1984
1985default-server [param*]
1986 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1987
1988 Arguments:
1989 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1990 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1991 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1992 details.
1993
1994
1995 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1996
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001997enable
1998 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1999
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002000peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002001 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2002 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2003 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2004 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2005 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2006 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2007
2008 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2009 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2010
2011 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2012 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2013 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2014 across all peers.
2015
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002016 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2017 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002018
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002019 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2020 "server" keyword explanation below).
2021
2022server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2023 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2024 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2025 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2026 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2027 of this "peers" section).
2028 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2029
2030
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002031 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002032 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002033 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002034 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2035 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2036 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002037
2038 backend mybackend
2039 mode tcp
2040 balance roundrobin
2041 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2042 stick on src
2043
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002044 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2045 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002046
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002047 Example:
2048 peers mypeers
2049 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2050 default-server ssl verify none
2051 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2052 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002053
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020543.6. Mailers
2055------------
2056It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2057If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2058in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2059
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002060mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002061 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2062 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2063
2064mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2065 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2066
2067 Example:
2068 mailers mymailers
2069 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2070 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2071
2072 backend mybackend
2073 mode tcp
2074 balance roundrobin
2075
2076 email-alert mailers mymailers
2077 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2078 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2079
2080 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2081 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2082
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002083timeout mail <time>
2084 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2085 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2086 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2087 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2088
2089 Example:
2090 mailers mymailers
2091 timeout mail 20s
2092 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020944. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002095----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002097Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002098 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002099 - frontend <name>
2100 - backend <name>
2101 - listen <name>
2102
2103A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2104its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2105section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002106section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002107
2108A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2109connections.
2110
2111A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2112to forward incoming connections.
2113
2114A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2115parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2116
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002117All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2118'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2119case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2120
2121Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2122logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2123proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2124However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2125name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2126
2127Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2128and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002129bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002130protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2131modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2132arbitrary criteria.
2133
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002134In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2135a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002136the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002137
2138 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2139 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2140 between responses and new requests.
2141
2142 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2143 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2144 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002145 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2146 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002147
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002148 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2149 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2150 client-facing connection remains open.
2151
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002152 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2153 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002154
2155The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2156frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2157following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002158weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002159
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002160 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002161
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002162 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2163 ----+-----+-----+----
2164 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2165 ----+-----+-----+----
2166 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2167 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2168 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2169 ----+-----+-----+----
2170 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002171
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002172
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002173
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021744.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2175--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002177The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2178limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2179they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2180limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002181marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002182option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002183and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2184with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2185specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002186
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002187
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002188 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2189------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2190acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002191appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002192backlog X X X -
2193balance X - X X
2194bind - X X -
2195bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002196block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002197capture cookie - X X -
2198capture request header - X X -
2199capture response header - X X -
2200clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002201compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002202contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2203cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002204declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002205default-server X - X X
2206default_backend X X X -
2207description - X X X
2208disabled X X X X
2209dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002210email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002211email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002212email-alert mailers X X X X
2213email-alert myhostname X X X X
2214email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002215enabled X X X X
2216errorfile X X X X
2217errorloc X X X X
2218errorloc302 X X X X
2219-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2220errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002221force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002222filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002223fullconn X - X X
2224grace X X X X
2225hash-type X - X X
2226http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002227http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002228http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002229http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002230http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002231http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002232http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002233id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002234ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002235load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002236log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002237log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002238log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002239log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002240max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002241maxconn X X X -
2242mode X X X X
2243monitor fail - X X -
2244monitor-net X X X -
2245monitor-uri X X X -
2246option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2247option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2248option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2249option allbackups (*) X - X X
2250option checkcache (*) X - X X
2251option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2252option contstats (*) X X X -
2253option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2254option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002255option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002256-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2257option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002258option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002259option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002260option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002261option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002262option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002263option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002264option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002265option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002266option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002267option httpchk X - X X
2268option httpclose (*) X X X X
2269option httplog X X X X
2270option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002271option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002272option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002273option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002274option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2275option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2276option logasap (*) X X X -
2277option mysql-check X - X X
2278option nolinger (*) X X X X
2279option originalto X X X X
2280option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002281option pgsql-check X - X X
2282option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002283option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002284option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002285option smtpchk X - X X
2286option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2287option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2288option splice-request (*) X X X X
2289option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002290option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002291option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2292option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2293-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002294option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002295option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2296option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2297option tcpka X X X X
2298option tcplog X X X X
2299option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002300external-check command X - X X
2301external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002302persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2303rate-limit sessions X X X -
2304redirect - X X X
2305redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2306redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2307reqadd - X X X
2308reqallow - X X X
2309reqdel - X X X
2310reqdeny - X X X
2311reqiallow - X X X
2312reqidel - X X X
2313reqideny - X X X
2314reqipass - X X X
2315reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002316reqitarpit - X X X
2317reqpass - X X X
2318reqrep - X X X
2319-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002320reqtarpit - X X X
2321retries X - X X
2322rspadd - X X X
2323rspdel - X X X
2324rspdeny - X X X
2325rspidel - X X X
2326rspideny - X X X
2327rspirep - X X X
2328rsprep - X X X
2329server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002330server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002331server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002332source X - X X
2333srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002334stats admin - X X X
2335stats auth X X X X
2336stats enable X X X X
2337stats hide-version X X X X
2338stats http-request - X X X
2339stats realm X X X X
2340stats refresh X X X X
2341stats scope X X X X
2342stats show-desc X X X X
2343stats show-legends X X X X
2344stats show-node X X X X
2345stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002346-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2347stick match - - X X
2348stick on - - X X
2349stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002350stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002351stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002352tcp-check connect - - X X
2353tcp-check expect - - X X
2354tcp-check send - - X X
2355tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002356tcp-request connection - X X -
2357tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002358tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002359tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002360tcp-response content - - X X
2361tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002362timeout check X - X X
2363timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002364timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002365timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2366timeout connect X - X X
2367timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2368timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2369timeout http-request X X X X
2370timeout queue X - X X
2371timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002372timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002373timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2374timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002375timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002376transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002377unique-id-format X X X -
2378unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002379use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002380use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002381------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2382 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023854.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2386---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002387
2388This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2389
2390
2391acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2392 Declare or complete an access list.
2393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2394 no | yes | yes | yes
2395 Example:
2396 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2397 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2398 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2399
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002400 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401
2402
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002403appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2404 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002405 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2407 no | no | yes | yes
2408 Arguments :
2409 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2410 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2411
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002412 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002413 checked in each cookie value.
2414
2415 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2416 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2417 milliseconds.
2418
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002419 request-learn
2420 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2421 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2422 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2423 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2424 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2425 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2426
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002427 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2428 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2429 data following this prefix.
2430
2431 Example :
2432 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2433
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002434 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2435 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002436
2437 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2438 2 modes are currently supported :
2439 - path-parameters :
2440 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2441 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2442 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2443 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2444 - query-string :
2445 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2446 query string.
2447
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002448 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2449 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2450 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002451
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002452 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2453 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002454
2455
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002456backlog <conns>
2457 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2459 yes | yes | yes | no
2460 Arguments :
2461 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2462 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002463 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002464
2465 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2466 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2467 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2468 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2469 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2470 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2471 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2472 backlog parameter.
2473
2474 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2475 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2476 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2477
2478 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2479
2480
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002481balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002482balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002483 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2485 yes | no | yes | yes
2486 Arguments :
2487 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2488 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2489 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2490 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2491
2492 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2493 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2494 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2495 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002496 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002497 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002498 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2499 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2500 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2501 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2502 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2503 it, so that you don't worry.
2504
2505 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2506 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2507 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2508 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2509 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2510 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2511 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2512 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002513
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002514 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2515 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2516 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2517 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2518 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2519 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2520 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2521 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2522
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002523 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002524 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002525 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2526 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002527 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002528 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2529 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2530 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2531 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2532 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002533 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2534 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2535 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2536 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2537 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2538 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002540 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2541 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2542 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2543 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2544 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2545 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2546 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2547 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002548 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002549 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002550 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2551 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2552 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002553
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002554 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2555 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2556 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2557 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2558 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2559 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2560 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2561 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2562 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2563 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2564 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2565 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002566
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002567 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002568 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2569 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2570 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2571 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2572 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2573 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2574 URIs start with a leading "/".
2575
2576 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2577 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2578 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2579 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2580
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002582 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2583
2584 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002585 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2586 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002587 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2588 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2589 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2590 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002591 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002592 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2593 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002594
2595 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2596 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2597 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2598 server will receive the request.
2599
2600 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2601 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2602 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2603 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2604 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002605 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2606 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2607 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002609 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2610 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2611 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2612 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2613 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002615 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002616 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2617 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2618 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2619
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002620 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2621 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2622 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2623
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002624 random
2625 random(<draws>)
2626 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002627 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2628 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2629 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2630 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002631 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2632 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2633 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2634 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2635 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2636 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2637 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2638 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2639 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2640 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2641 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2642 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2643 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2644 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2645 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2646 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2647 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2648 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2649 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2650 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002651
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002652 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002653 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002654 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2655 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2656 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2657 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2658 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2659 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002660 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002661 used instead.
2662
2663 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2664 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2665 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2666 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2667
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002668 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2669 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2670 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2671
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002672 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002673
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002674 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002675 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2676 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002677
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002678 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2679 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2680 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002681
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002682 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2683 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2684 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2685 NTLM relies on.
2686
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687 Examples :
2688 balance roundrobin
2689 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002690 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002691 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2692 balance hdr(host)
2693 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002694
2695 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2696 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002698 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002699 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2700 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2701 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2702 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2703
2704 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2705 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2706 defaults to 16 kB.
2707
2708 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2709 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2710
2711 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2712 Round Robin.
2713
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002714 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002715 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2716 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2717 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2718
2719 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2720
2721 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002722 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002723 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2724 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2725 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002726
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002727 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002728
2729
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002730bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2731bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002732 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2734 no | yes | yes | no
2735 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002736 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2737 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2738 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2739 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002740 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002741 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2742 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2743 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2744 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2745 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2746 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2747 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002748 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2749 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2750 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2751 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2752 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2753 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2754 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002755 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2756 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2757 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002758 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2759 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2760 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2761 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002762 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2763 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2764 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002765
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002766 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2767 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002768 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2769 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2770 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002771 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2772 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2773 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2774 the range.
2775
2776 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2777 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2778 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2779 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2780 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2781 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2782 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002783 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002784 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002785
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002786 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002787 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002788 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2789 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2790 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2791 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2792 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2793 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2794
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002795 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2796 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2797 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2798 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002800 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2801 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2802 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2803 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2804 in a frontend.
2805
2806 Example :
2807 listen http_proxy
2808 bind :80,:443
2809 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002810 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002812 listen http_https_proxy
2813 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002814 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002815
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002816 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2817 bind ipv6@:80
2818 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2819 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2820
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002821 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002822 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002823
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002824 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2825 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2826 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2827 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2828 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2829
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002830 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002831 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832
2833
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002834bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002835 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2837 yes | yes | yes | yes
2838 Arguments :
2839 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2840 may be used to override a default value.
2841
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002842 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002843 option may be combined with other numbers.
2844
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002845 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002846 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2847 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2848 missing from all processes.
2849
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002850 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002851 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002852 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2853 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2854 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2855 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2856 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002857 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002858
2859 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2860 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2861 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2862 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2863 and 'even' instances.
2864
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002865 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2866 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2867 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2868 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002869
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002870 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2871 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2872
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002873 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2874 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2875 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2876
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002877 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2878 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2879
2880 Example :
2881 listen app_ip1
2882 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002883 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002884
2885 listen app_ip2
2886 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002887 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002888
2889 listen management
2890 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002891 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002892
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002893 listen management
2894 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2895 bind-process 1-4
2896
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002897 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002898
2899
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002900block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002901 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2903 no | yes | yes | yes
2904
2905 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2906 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002907 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002908 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002910 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2911 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2912 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002913
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002914 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2915 "http-request deny" instead.
2916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002917 Example:
2918 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2919 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2920 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002921 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2922 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2923 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002925 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2926 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2927 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002928
2929capture cookie <name> len <length>
2930 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2932 no | yes | yes | no
2933 Arguments :
2934 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2935 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2936 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2937 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002938 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
2940 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2941 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2942 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2943 right if it exceeds <length>.
2944
2945 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2946 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2947 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2948 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2949
2950 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2951 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2952 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2953
2954 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2955 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2956 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002957 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2958 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2959 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002960
2961 Example:
2962 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2963
2964 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002965 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966
2967
2968capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002969 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2971 no | yes | yes | no
2972 Arguments :
2973 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002974 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002975 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2976 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2977 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2978
2979 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2980 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2981 it exceeds <length>.
2982
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002983 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002984 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2985 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002986 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2987 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2988 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2989 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002990 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002991 environments to find where the request came from.
2992
2993 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2994 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2995 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2996 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002998 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2999 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3000 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3001 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3002 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003003
3004 Example:
3005 capture request header Host len 15
3006 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003007 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003009 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010 about logging.
3011
3012
3013capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003014 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3016 no | yes | yes | no
3017 Arguments :
3018 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003019 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003020 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3021 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3022 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3023
3024 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3025 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3026 it exceeds <length>.
3027
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003028 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003029 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3030 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3031 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003032 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3033 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3034 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3035 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003037 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3038 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3039 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3040 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3041 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003042
3043 Example:
3044 capture response header Content-length len 9
3045 capture response header Location len 15
3046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003047 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003048 about logging.
3049
3050
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003051clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003052 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3054 yes | yes | yes | no
3055 Arguments :
3056 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3057 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3058 as explained at the top of this document.
3059
3060 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3061 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3062 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3063 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3064 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3065 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3066 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3067 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003068 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003070 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071
3072 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3073 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3074 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3075 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3076 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3077 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3078
3079 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3080 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3081
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003082 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3083 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003084
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003085compression algo <algorithm> ...
3086compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003087compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003088 Enable HTTP compression.
3089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3090 yes | yes | yes | yes
3091 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003092 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3093 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3094 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3095
3096 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003097 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3098 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3099 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003100
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003101 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003102 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003103
3104 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3105 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3106 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3107 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3108 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003109 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003110
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003111 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3112 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3113 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3114 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3115 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3116 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3117 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003118 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003119
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003120 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003121 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003122 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3123 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3124 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3125 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3126 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003127
3128 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3129 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3130 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3131 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3132 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003133 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3134 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3135 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3136 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3137 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003138 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3139 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003140
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003141 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003142 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3143 "Accept-Encoding" header
3144 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003145 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003146 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3147 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3148 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3149 "multipart"
3150 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3151 header
3152 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3153 and later
3154 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3155 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003156 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003157
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003158 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003159
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003160 Examples :
3161 compression algo gzip
3162 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003164
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003165contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003166 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3168 yes | no | yes | yes
3169 Arguments :
3170 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3171 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3172 as explained at the top of this document.
3173
3174 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003175 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003176 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003177 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003178 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3179 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3180 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3181
3182 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3183 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3184 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3185 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3186 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3187 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3188
3189 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3190 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3191 instead.
3192
3193 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3194 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3195
3196
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003197cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003198 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3199 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003200 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3203 yes | no | yes | yes
3204 Arguments :
3205 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3206 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3207 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3208 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3209 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3210 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003211 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003212 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3213 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3214
3215 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3216 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3217 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3218 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3219 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3220 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003221 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3222 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003223 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003224 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3225 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003226
3227 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003228 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003229
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003230 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003231 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3232 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003233 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003234 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3235 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3236 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3237 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3238 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3239 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3240 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241
3242 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3243 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3244 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3245 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3246 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3247 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3248 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3249 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3250 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003251 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003252 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3253 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3254 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003255
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003256 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3257 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3258 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003259 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3260 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3261 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3262 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003263 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3264 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3265 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003266
3267 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3268 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3269 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3270 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3271 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3272 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3273 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3274 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3275 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3276
3277 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3278 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3279 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3280 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3281 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3282 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3283 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3284 persistence cookie in the cache.
3285 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3286
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003287 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3288 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3289 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3290 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3291 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003292 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003293 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3294 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3295 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3296 they logout.
3297
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003298 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3299 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3300 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3301 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3302
3303 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3304 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3305 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3306 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3307 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3308 this attribute.
3309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003310 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003311 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003312 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3313 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3314 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3315 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3316 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3317 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003318
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003319 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3320 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3321 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3322 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3323 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3324 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3325 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3326 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003327 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003328 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3329 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3330 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3331 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3332 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3333 the site.
3334
3335 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3336 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3337 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3338 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3339 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3340 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3341 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3342 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3343 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3344 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3345 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3346 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3347 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003348 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003349 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3350 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3351
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003352 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3353 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3354 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3355 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3356 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3357 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003359 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3360 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3361 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3362 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003363
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003364 Examples :
3365 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3366 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3367 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003368 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003369
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003370 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003371
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003372
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003373declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3374 Declares a capture slot.
3375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3376 no | yes | yes | no
3377 Arguments:
3378 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3379
3380 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3381 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3382 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3383 for use in the response.
3384
3385 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003386 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003387 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3388
3389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003390default-server [param*]
3391 Change default options for a server in a backend
3392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3393 yes | no | yes | yes
3394 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003395 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3396 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3397 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3398 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003399
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003400 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003401 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3402
3403 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003404
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003405
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406default_backend <backend>
3407 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | yes | yes | no
3410 Arguments :
3411 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3412
3413 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3414 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3415 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3416 will catch all undetermined requests.
3417
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003418 Example :
3419
3420 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3421 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3422 default_backend dynamic
3423
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003424 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003427description <string>
3428 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 no | yes | yes | yes
3431 Arguments : string
3432
3433 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3434 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3435 it describes.
3436 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3437
3438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003439disabled
3440 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3442 yes | yes | yes | yes
3443 Arguments : none
3444
3445 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3446 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3447 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3448 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3449 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3450 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3451 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3452
3453 See also : "enabled"
3454
3455
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003456dispatch <address>:<port>
3457 Set a default server address
3458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3459 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003460 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003461
3462 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3463 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3464 during start-up.
3465
3466 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3467 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3468 possible with normal servers.
3469
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003470 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003471 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3472 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3473 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3474 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3475
3476 See also : "server"
3477
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003478
3479dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3480 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3482 yes | no | yes | yes
3483 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3484
3485 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003486 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003487 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3488 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003489 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003490 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003492enabled
3493 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3495 yes | yes | yes | yes
3496 Arguments : none
3497
3498 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3499 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3500
3501 See also : "disabled"
3502
3503
3504errorfile <code> <file>
3505 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3507 yes | yes | yes | yes
3508 Arguments :
3509 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003510 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3511 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003512
3513 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003514 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003515 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003516 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3517 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518
3519 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3520 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3521 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3522
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003523 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003525 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3526 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3527 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3528 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3529
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003530 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3531 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003532 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003533 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3534 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3535 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003537 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3538 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3539 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003540 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003541 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3542
3543 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3544
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003545 Example :
3546 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003547 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003548 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3549 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3550
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003551
3552errorloc <code> <url>
3553errorloc302 <code> <url>
3554 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3556 yes | yes | yes | yes
3557 Arguments :
3558 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003559 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3560 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003561
3562 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3563 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3564 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3565 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003566 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003567
3568 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3569 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3570 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3571
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003572 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3573
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003574 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3575 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3576 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3577 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003578 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003579 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3580 request.
3581
3582 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3583
3584
3585errorloc303 <code> <url>
3586 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3588 yes | yes | yes | yes
3589 Arguments :
3590 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003591 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3592 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003593
3594 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3595 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3596 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3597 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003598 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003599
3600 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3601 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3602 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3603
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003604 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3605
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003606 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3607 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3608 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3609 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003610 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003611
3612 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3613
3614
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003615email-alert from <emailaddr>
3616 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003617 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003618 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3619 yes | yes | yes | yes
3620
3621 Arguments :
3622
3623 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3624
3625 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3626 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3627
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003628 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003629 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3630 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003631
3632
3633email-alert level <level>
3634 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3635 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3636 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3637 yes | yes | yes | yes
3638
3639 Arguments :
3640
3641 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3642 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3643 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3644
3645 By default level is alert
3646
3647 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3648 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3649 for the proxy.
3650
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003651 Alerts are sent when :
3652
3653 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3654 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3655 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3656 is notice or lower
3657 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3658 and a health check status update occurs
3659
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003660 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3661 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003662 section 3.6 about mailers.
3663
3664
3665email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3666 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3668 yes | yes | yes | yes
3669
3670 Arguments :
3671
3672 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3673
3674 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3675 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3676
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003677 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3678 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003679
3680
3681email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3682 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3683 mailers.
3684 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3685 yes | yes | yes | yes
3686
3687 Arguments :
3688
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003689 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003690
3691 By default the systems hostname is used.
3692
3693 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3694 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3695 for the proxy.
3696
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003697 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3698 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003699
3700
3701email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003702 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003703 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3704 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3705 yes | yes | yes | yes
3706
3707 Arguments :
3708
3709 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3710
3711 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3712 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3713
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003714 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003715 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3716
3717
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003718force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3719 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3720 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003721 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003722
3723 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3724 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3725 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3726 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3727 marked down for maintenance operations.
3728
3729 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3730 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3731 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3732 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3733 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3734 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3735 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3736 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3737 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3738
3739 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3740 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3741 is used.
3742
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003743 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003744 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003745
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003746
3747filter <name> [param*]
3748 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3750 no | yes | yes | yes
3751 Arguments :
3752 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3753 referenced in section 9.
3754
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003755 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003756 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003757 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3758 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003759
3760 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3761 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3762
3763 Example:
3764 listen
3765 bind *:80
3766
3767 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3768 filter compression
3769 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3770
3771 compression algo gzip
3772 compression offload
3773
3774 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3775
3776 See also : section 9.
3777
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003778
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003779fullconn <conns>
3780 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3782 yes | no | yes | yes
3783 Arguments :
3784 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3785 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3786
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003787 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003788 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003789 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003790 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3791 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3792 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3793 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3794 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003795 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003796
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003797 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3798 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003799 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3800 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3801 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003803 Example :
3804 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3805 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3806 # connections.
3807 backend dynamic
3808 fullconn 10000
3809 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3810 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3811
3812 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3813
3814
3815grace <time>
3816 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003818 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003819 Arguments :
3820 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3821 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3822 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3823
3824 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3825 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003826 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003827 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3828
3829 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3830 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3831 simplify it.
3832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003833
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003834hash-balance-factor <factor>
3835 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3837 yes | no | no | yes
3838 Arguments :
3839 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3840 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3841 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3842
3843 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3844 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3845 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3846 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3847 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3848 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3849 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3850
3851 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3852 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3853 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3854 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3855 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3856
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003857 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3858 consistent hashing mechanism.
3859
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003860 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3861
3862
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003863hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003864 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3866 yes | no | yes | yes
3867 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003868 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3869 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003870
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003871 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3872 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3873 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3874 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3875 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3876 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3877 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3878 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3879 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3880 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003881
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003882 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3883 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3884 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3885 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3886 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3887 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3888 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3889 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3890 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3891 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3892 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3893 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3894 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003895 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3896 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003897
3898 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3899
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003900 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003901 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3902 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3903 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003904 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3905 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3906 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003907
3908 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3909 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003910 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3911 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3912 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3913 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3914
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003915 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3916 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3917 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3918 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3919 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3920 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3921 parameter.
3922
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003923 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3924 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3925 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3926 used on strings.
3927
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003928 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3929
3930 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3931 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3932 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3933 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3934 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3935 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3936 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3937 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3938 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3939 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3940 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3941 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003942
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003943 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3944 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3945 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003946
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003947 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003948
3949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003950http-check disable-on-404
3951 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003953 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003954 Arguments : none
3955
3956 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3957 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3958 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3959 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3960 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3961 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3962 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3963 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003964 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3965 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3966 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3967
3968 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3969
3970
3971http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003972 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003974 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003975 Arguments :
3976 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3977 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003978 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003979 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3980 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3981 details on the supported keywords.
3982
3983 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3984 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3985 with the usual backslash ('\').
3986
3987 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3988 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3989 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3990 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3991 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3992
3993 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003994 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003995 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3996 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3997 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3998
3999 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004000 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004001 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4002 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4003 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4004 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4005
4006 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004007 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004008 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4009 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4010 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4011 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4012 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004013 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004014 trace).
4015
4016 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004017 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004018 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4019 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4020 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4021 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4022 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004023 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004024
4025 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4026 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4027 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4028 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4029 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4030 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4031 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4032 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4033
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004034 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4035 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4036 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4037
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004038 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4039 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4040
4041 Examples :
4042 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004043 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004044
4045 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004046 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004047
4048 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004049 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004050
4051 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004052 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004053
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004054 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004055
4056
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004057http-check send-state
4058 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4060 yes | no | yes | yes
4061 Arguments : none
4062
4063 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4064 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4065 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4066 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4067 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4068
4069 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4070 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4071 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4072 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4073 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004074 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4075 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4076 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4077
4078 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4079 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4080 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4081
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004082 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4083 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4084 checked in multiple backends.
4085
4086 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4087 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4088
4089 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4090 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4091 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4092 one fails.
4093
4094 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4095 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4096 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4097
4098 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4099 server's queue.
4100
4101 Example of a header received by the application server :
4102 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4103 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4104
4105 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004107
4108http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004109 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4110
4111 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4112 no | yes | yes | yes
4113
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004114 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4115 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4116 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4117 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4118 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004119
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004120 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4121 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004123 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004125 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4126 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4127 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4128 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004130 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4131 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4132 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4133 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004135 Example:
4136 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4137 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4138 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004140 http-request allow if nagios
4141 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4142 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4143 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004145 Example:
4146 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4147 acl add path /addacl
4148 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004150 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004152 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4153 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004155 Example:
4156 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4157 acl setmap path /setmap
4158 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004162 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4163 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004164
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004165 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4166 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004168http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004170 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4171 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4172 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4173 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4174 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4175 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4176 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4177 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004181 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4182 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4183 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4184 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4185 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4186 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4187 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4188 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004190http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004191
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004192 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4193 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004194
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004198 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4199 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4200 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4201 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4202 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004204 Example:
4205 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4206 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004207
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004208http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004210 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004211
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004212http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4213 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004215 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4216 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4217 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4218 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4219 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4220 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4221 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4222 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4223 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004224
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004225 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4226 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4227 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4228 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4229 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4230 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004232http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4235 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4236 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4237 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4238 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4239 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004242
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004243 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004245http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4248 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4249 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4250 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4251 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4252 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004253
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004254http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4257 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4258 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4259 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4260 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004261
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004262http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4263
4264 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4265 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4266 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4267 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004268 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4269 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004270
4271 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004273http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004275 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4276 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4277 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4278 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4279 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004281http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004283 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4284 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4285 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4286 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4289 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004291 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4292 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4293 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4294 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4295 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4296 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4297 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4298 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300 Example:
4301 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004302
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004303 # applied to:
4304 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 # outputs:
4307 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4312 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004314 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4315 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4316 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4317 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004319 Example:
4320 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004322 # applied to:
4323 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004325 # outputs:
4326 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004328http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4329http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004331 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4332 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4333 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4338 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4339 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004341http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004343 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4344 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4345 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4346 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4347 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004349 Arguments:
4350 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4351 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004352
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004353 Example:
4354 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4355 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4358 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004360http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004362 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4363 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4364 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004366 Arguments:
4367 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4368 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004370 Example:
4371 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4372 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4375 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4376 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004378http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004380 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4381 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4382 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4383 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4384 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004385
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004386 Example:
4387 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4388 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4389 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4390 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4391 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4392 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4393 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4394 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4395 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004396
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004397http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004398
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004399 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4400 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4401 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4402 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4403 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4406 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004407
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004408 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4409 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4410 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4411 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4412 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4413 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4414 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4415 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4416 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4421 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4422 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4423 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4424 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4425 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4426 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004428http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4431 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4432 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004433
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004434http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4437 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4438 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4439 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4440 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4441 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4442 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4443 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004446
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004447 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4448 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4449 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4450 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4451 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4452 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004454 Example :
4455 # prepend the host name before the path
4456 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004458http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004459
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004460 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4461 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4462 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4463 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4464 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004466http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004467
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004468 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4469 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4470 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4471 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4472 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4473 values have higher priority.
4474 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4475 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4476 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4477 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4478 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004479
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004480http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004482 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4483 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4484 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4485 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4486 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4487 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4488 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004489
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004490 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004491
4492 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004493 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4494 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4497 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4498 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4499 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4500 privacy.
4501
4502 Arguments :
4503 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4504 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004505
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004506 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004507 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4508 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4509
4510 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4511 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4512
4513http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4514
4515 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4516 expression.
4517
4518 Arguments:
4519 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4520 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004521
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004522 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004523 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4524 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4525
4526 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4527 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4528 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4529
4530http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4531
4532 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4533 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4534 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4535 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4536 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4537 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4538 information from the request.
4539
4540 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4541
4542http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4543
4544 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4545 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4546 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4547 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4548 path and the query string.
4549 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4550
4551http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4552
4553 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4554 inline.
4555
4556 Arguments:
4557 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4558 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4559 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4560 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4561 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4562 (request and response)
4563 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4564 processing
4565 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4566 processing
4567 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4568 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4569 and '_'.
4570
4571 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4572 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004573
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004574 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004575 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004577http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4578 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004579
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004580 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4581 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4582 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4583 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4584 agent name must be used.
4585
4586 Arguments:
4587 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4588
4589 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4590 configuration.
4591
4592http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4593
4594 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4595 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4596 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4597 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4598 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4599 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4600 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4601 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4602 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4603 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4604 action.
4605 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4606 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4607 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4608 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4609 you fully understand how it works.
4610
4611http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4612
4613 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4614 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4615 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4616 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4617 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4618 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4619 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4620 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4621 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4622 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4623 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4624 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4625 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4626
4627http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4628http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4629http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4630
4631 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4632 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4633 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4634 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4635 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4636 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4637 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4638 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4639 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4640 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4641 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4642 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4643
4644 Arguments :
4645 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4646 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4647 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4648 select which table entry to update the counters.
4649
4650 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4651 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4652 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4653 that table until the session ends.
4654
4655 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4656 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4657 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4658 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4659 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4660 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4661 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4662 useful information.
4663
4664 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4665 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4666 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4667 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4668 checks that make use of it.
4669
4670http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4671
4672 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004673
4674 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004675 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004677http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004679 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4680 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4681 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004682
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004683
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004684http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004685 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4686
4687 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4688 no | yes | yes | yes
4689
4690 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4691 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4692 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4693 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4694 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4695 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4696
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004697 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4698 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004699
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004700 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004701
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004702 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4703 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4704 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4705 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004706
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004707 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4708 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4709 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4710 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004712 Example:
4713 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004715 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004716
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004717 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4718 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004719
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004720 Example:
4721 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004723 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004724
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004725 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4726 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004727
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004728 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4729 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004730
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004731http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004732
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004733 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4734 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4735 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4736 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4737 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4738 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4739 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4740 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004741
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004742http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004743
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004744 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4745 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4746 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4747 example, or to pass some internal information.
4748 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4749 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4750 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004752http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004754 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4755 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004756
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004757http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004759 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004760
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004761http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004762
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004763 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4764 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4765 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4766 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4767 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4768 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4769 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004770
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004771 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4772 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4773 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4774 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4775 keyword.
4776 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4777 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004778
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004779http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004780
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004781 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4782 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4783 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4784 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4785 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4786 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004787
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004788http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004789
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004790 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004792http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004793
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004794 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4795 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4796 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4797 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4798 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4799 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004800
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004801http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004802
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004803 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4804 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004806http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004807
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004808 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4809 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4810 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4811 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4812 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4813 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004815http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4816 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004817
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004818 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4819 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4820 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4821 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4822 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4823 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4824 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4825 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004826
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004827 Example:
4828 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004830 # applied to:
4831 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004832
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004833 # outputs:
4834 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004837
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004838http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4839 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004841 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4842 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4843 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4844 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004846 Example:
4847 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004848
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004849 # applied to:
4850 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004852 # outputs:
4853 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004855http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4856http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004857
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004858 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4859 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4860 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004862http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004864 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4865 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4866 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004867
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004868http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004870 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4871 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4872 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4873 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4874 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004875
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004876 Arguments:
4877 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004878
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004879 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4880 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004881
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004882http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004883
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004884 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4885 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4886 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004887
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004888http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4889
4890 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4891 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4892 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4893 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4894 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4895
4896http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4897
4898 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4899 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4900 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4901 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4902 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4903 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4904 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4905 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4906 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4907
4908http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4909
4910 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4911 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4912 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4913 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4914 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4915 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4916 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4917
4918http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4919
4920 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4921 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4922 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4923 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4924 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4925 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4926 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4927 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4928
4929http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4930 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4931
4932 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4933 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4934 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4935 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004936
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004937 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004938 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4939 http-response set-status 431
4940 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4941 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004942
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004943http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004945 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4946 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4947 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4948 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4949 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4950 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4951 based on some information from the request.
4952
4953 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4954
4955http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4956
4957 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4958 inline.
4959
4960 Arguments:
4961 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4962 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4963 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4964 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4965 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4966 (request and response)
4967 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4968 processing
4969 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4970 processing
4971 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4972 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4973 and '_'.
4974
4975 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4976 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004977
4978 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004979 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004981http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004983 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4984 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4985 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4986 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4987 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4988 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4989 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4990 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4991 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4992 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4993 action.
4994 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4995 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4996 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4997 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4998 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005000http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5001http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5002http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005003
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005004 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5005 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5006 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5007 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5008 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5009 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5010
5011http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5012
5013 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5014 about <var-name>.
5015
5016 Example:
5017 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5018
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005019
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005020http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5021 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5022
5023 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5024 yes | no | yes | yes
5025
5026 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005027 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5028 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5029 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005030
5031 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5032
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005033 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5034 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5035 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5036 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5037 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5038 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5039 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5040 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5041 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5042 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005043
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005044 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5045 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5046 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5047 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5048 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5049 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5050 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5051 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005052
5053 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5054 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5055 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5056 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5057 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5058 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5059 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5060 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5061 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5062 downsides of rare connection failures.
5063
5064 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5065 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5066 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5067 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5068 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5069 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005070 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005071 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5072 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5073 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5074 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5075 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5076
5077 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005078 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5079 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5080 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005081
5082 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005083 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005084
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005085 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5086 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005087
5088 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5089 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5090 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5091
5092 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5093 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5094 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5095
5096 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5097
5098
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005099http-send-name-header [<header>]
5100 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5101
5102 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5103 yes | no | yes | yes
5104
5105 Arguments :
5106
5107 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5108
5109 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005110 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005111 is added with the header string proved.
5112
5113 See also : "server"
5114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005115id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005116 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5118 no | yes | yes | yes
5119 Arguments : none
5120
5121 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5122 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5123 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005124
5125
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005126ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5127 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5128 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005129 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005130
5131 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5132 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5133 and running).
5134
5135 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5136 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5137 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005138 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005139 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5140
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005141 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5142 "unless" condition is met.
5143
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005144 Example:
5145 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5146 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5147 ignore-persist if url_static
5148
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005149 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5150
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005151load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5152 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5153 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5154 yes | no | yes | yes
5155
5156 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5157 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5158 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005159 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005160 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5161 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5162 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5163 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5164
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005165 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005166 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005167 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005168
5169 Arguments:
5170 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5171 named "server-state-file".
5172
5173 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5174 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5175 name is used as a file name.
5176
5177 none don't load any stat for this backend
5178
5179 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005180 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5181 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5182 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005183 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005184 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005185
5186 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5187 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5188
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005189 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005190
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005191 global
5192 stats socket /tmp/socket
5193 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005194
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005195 defaults
5196 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005197
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005198 backend bk
5199 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5200 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005201
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005202
5203 Then one can run :
5204
5205 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5206
5207 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5208
5209 1
5210 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5211 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5212 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5213
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005214 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005215
5216 global
5217 stats socket /tmp/socket
5218 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5219
5220 defaults
5221 load-server-state-from-file local
5222
5223 backend bk
5224 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5225 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5226
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005227
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005228 Then one can run :
5229
5230 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5231
5232 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5233
5234 1
5235 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5236 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5237 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5238
5239 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5240 "show servers state"
5241
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005243log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005244log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005245no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005246 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5248 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005249
5250 Prefix :
5251 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5252 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5253 prefix does not allow arguments.
5254
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005255 Arguments :
5256 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5257 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5258 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5259 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5260 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5261 parameter.
5262
5263 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5264 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5265
5266 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5267 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5268 standard syslog port).
5269
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005270 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5271 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5272 standard syslog port).
5273
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005274 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5275 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5276 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005277 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005278
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005279 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5280 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5281 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5282 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5283 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5284 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5285 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5286 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5287 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5288 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5289 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5290 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5291 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5292 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5293 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5294 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005295 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5296 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005297
5298 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5299 and "fd@2", see above.
5300
5301 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5302 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005303
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005304 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5305 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5306 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5307 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5308 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5309 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5310 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5311 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5312 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5313 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005314 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005315
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005316 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5317 one of the following :
5318
5319 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5320 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5321
5322 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5323 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5324
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005325 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5326 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5327 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5328 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5329 systemd logger consumes.
5330
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005331 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5332 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5333 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5334 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5335
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005336 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5337
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005338 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5339 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5340 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5341
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005342 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5343 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5344 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5345 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005346
5347 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5348 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5349 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005350 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5351 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5352 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5353 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5354 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005355
5356 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5357
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005358 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5359 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5360 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005361
5362 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5363 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5364 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5365 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5366
5367 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5368 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005369
5370 Example :
5371 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005372 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5373 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5374 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005375 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5376 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005377 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005378
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005379
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005380log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005381 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5382 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5383 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005384
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005385 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5386 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5387 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5388 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5389 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005390
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005391 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5392 "option httplog" directives.
5393
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005394log-format-sd <string>
5395 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5396 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5397 yes | yes | yes | no
5398
5399 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5400 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5401 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5402 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5403 which covers the log format string in depth.
5404
5405 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5406 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5407
5408 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5409 log format to "rfc5424".
5410
5411 Example :
5412 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5413
5414
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005415log-tag <string>
5416 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5417 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5418 yes | yes | yes | yes
5419
5420 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5421 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5422 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5423 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5424 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5425 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5426 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5427 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5428 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005429
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005430max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5431 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5432 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5433 yes | no | yes | yes
5434
5435 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5436 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5437 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5438 servers.
5439
5440 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5441 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5442 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5443 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5444 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005445 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005446 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5447 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5448 picking a different server.
5449
5450 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5451 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5452 even if they have to be queued.
5453
5454 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5455 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5456
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005457max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5458 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5459 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5460 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005461
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005462maxconn <conns>
5463 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | yes | yes | no
5466 Arguments :
5467 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5468 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5469 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5470 closes.
5471
5472 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5473 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5474 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5475 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005476 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5477 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5478 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5479 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005480
5481 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5482 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5483 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5484
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005485 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5486 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005487
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005488 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5489
5490
5491mode { tcp|http|health }
5492 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | yes | yes | yes
5495 Arguments :
5496 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5497 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5498 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5499 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5500
5501 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5502 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5503 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5504 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5505 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5506
5507 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005508 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5509 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5510 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5511 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5512 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5513 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5514 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005515
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005516 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5517 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5518 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005519
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005520 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005521 defaults http_instances
5522 mode http
5523
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005524 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005525
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005526
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005527monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005528 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5530 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005531 Arguments :
5532 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5533 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005534 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005535 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5536 backend and its backup.
5537
5538 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5539 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5540 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5541 servers in a list of backends.
5542
5543 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5544 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5545 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5546 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5547 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5548 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5549 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005550 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5551 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005552
5553 Example:
5554 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005555 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005556 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5557 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5558 monitor-uri /site_alive
5559 monitor fail if site_dead
5560
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005561 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005562
5563
5564monitor-net <source>
5565 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 yes | yes | yes | no
5568 Arguments :
5569 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5570 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5571 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5572 followed by a mask.
5573
5574 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5575 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005576 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005577 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5578
5579 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5580 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5581 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5582 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005583 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5584 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5585 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005586
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005587 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5588 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5589 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5590 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5591 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5592 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005593
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005594 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5595 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005596
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005597 Example :
5598 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5599 frontend www
5600 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5601
5602 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5603
5604
5605monitor-uri <uri>
5606 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5608 yes | yes | yes | no
5609 Arguments :
5610 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5611 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5612
5613 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5614 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5615 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5616 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5617 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5618 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5619 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5620 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5621
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005622 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5623 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5624 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5625 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5626 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5627 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5628 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5629 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005630
5631 Example :
5632 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5633 frontend www
5634 mode http
5635 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5636
5637 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5638
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005639
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005640option abortonclose
5641no option abortonclose
5642 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5644 yes | no | yes | yes
5645 Arguments : none
5646
5647 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5648 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5649 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5650 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005651 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005652 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5653 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5654 encountered while delivering the response.
5655
5656 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5657 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5658 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5659 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5660 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5661 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005662 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005663 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005664 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005665 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5666 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5667 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5668
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005669 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5670 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005671 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5672 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5673 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5674 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5675 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5676 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005677 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005678
5679 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5680 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5681
5682 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5683
5684
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005685option accept-invalid-http-request
5686no option accept-invalid-http-request
5687 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5689 yes | yes | yes | no
5690 Arguments : none
5691
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005692 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005693 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005694 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005695 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5696 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5697 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5698 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5699 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005700 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5701 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5702 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5703 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005704 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005705 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005706 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5707 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5708 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005709
5710 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5711 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5712 been confirmed.
5713
5714 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5715 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005716 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5717 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005718 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5719
5720 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5721 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5722
5723 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5724 stats socket.
5725
5726
5727option accept-invalid-http-response
5728no option accept-invalid-http-response
5729 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5731 yes | no | yes | yes
5732 Arguments : none
5733
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005734 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005735 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005736 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005737 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5738 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5739 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5740 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5741 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005742 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5743 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5744 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005745
5746 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5747 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5748 been confirmed.
5749
5750 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5751 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5752 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5753 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5754
5755 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5756 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5757
5758 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5759 stats socket.
5760
5761
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005762option allbackups
5763no option allbackups
5764 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5766 yes | no | yes | yes
5767 Arguments : none
5768
5769 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5770 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5771 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5772 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5773 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5774 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5775 order between the backup servers anymore.
5776
5777 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5778 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5779
5780 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5781 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5782
5783
5784option checkcache
5785no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005786 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | no | yes | yes
5789 Arguments : none
5790
5791 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5792 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005793 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005794 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5795 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005796 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005797
5798 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005799 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005800 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005801 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5802 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005803 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005804 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005805 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5806 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005807 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005808 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5809 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005810 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005811 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5812 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5813 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5814 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5815 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5816 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5817 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5818 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5819 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5820
5821 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005822 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005823 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005824 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005825 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5826
5827 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5828 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005829 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005830 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005831
5832 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5833 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5834
5835
5836option clitcpka
5837no option clitcpka
5838 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5840 yes | yes | yes | no
5841 Arguments : none
5842
5843 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5844 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005845 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005846 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5847
5848 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5849 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5850 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5851 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5852
5853 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5854 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5855 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5856 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5857 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5858
5859 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5860
5861 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5862 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5863 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5864
5865 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5866 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5867
5868 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5869
5870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005871option contstats
5872 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5874 yes | yes | yes | no
5875 Arguments : none
5876
5877 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5878 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5879 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5880 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005881 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5882 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5883 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5884 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5885 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005886
5887
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005888option dontlog-normal
5889no option dontlog-normal
5890 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5892 yes | yes | yes | no
5893 Arguments : none
5894
5895 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5896 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5897 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5898 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5899 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5900 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5901 logged.
5902
5903 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5904 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5905 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005907 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005908 logging.
5909
5910
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005911option dontlognull
5912no option dontlognull
5913 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5915 yes | yes | yes | no
5916 Arguments : none
5917
5918 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5919 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5920 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5921 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5922 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5923 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005924 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5925 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5926 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005927
5928 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005929 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005930 would not be logged.
5931
5932 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5933 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5934
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005935 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5936 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005937
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005938
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005939option forceclose (deprecated)
5940no option forceclose (deprecated)
5941 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005942
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005943 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005944
5945
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005946option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005947 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5949 yes | yes | yes | yes
5950 Arguments :
5951 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5952 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005953 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005954 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005955
5956 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5957 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5958 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5959 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5960 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5961 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5962 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005963 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5964 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5965 possible that the client has already brought one.
5966
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005967 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005968 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005969 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005970 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005971 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005972 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005973
5974 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5975 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5976 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5977 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5978 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5979 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5980 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5981
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005982 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5983 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5984 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5985 are under the control of the end-user.
5986
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005987 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005988 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5989 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005990 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5991 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5992 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005993
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005994 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005995 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5996 frontend www
5997 mode http
5998 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5999
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006000 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6001 backend www
6002 mode http
6003 option forwardfor header X-Client
6004
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006005 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006006 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006007
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006008
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006009option http-buffer-request
6010no option http-buffer-request
6011 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 yes | yes | yes | yes
6014 Arguments : none
6015
6016 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6017 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6018 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6019 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6020 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6021 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6022 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6023 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006024 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006025 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6026 default.
6027
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006028 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006029
6030
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006031option http-ignore-probes
6032no option http-ignore-probes
6033 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6035 yes | yes | yes | no
6036 Arguments : none
6037
6038 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6039 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6040 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6041 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6042 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6043 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6044 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6045 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6046 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006047 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6048 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006049 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6050
6051 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6052 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6053 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6054 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6055 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6056 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6057 are often the only way to detect them.
6058
6059 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6060 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6061
6062 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6063
6064
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006065option http-keep-alive
6066no option http-keep-alive
6067 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6069 yes | yes | yes | yes
6070 Arguments : none
6071
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006072 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6073 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006074 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6075 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6076 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6077 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6078 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006079
6080 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6081 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006082 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6083 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6084 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6085 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6086 situations where this option may be useful :
6087
6088 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006089 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006090
6091 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6092 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6093
6094 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6095 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6096 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6097 request.
6098
6099 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6100 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006101 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6102 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6103 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006104
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006105 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6106 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6107 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6108 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6109 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6110 not set.
6111
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006112 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006113 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6114 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006115
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006116 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006117 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006118 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006119
6120
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006121option http-no-delay
6122no option http-no-delay
6123 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 yes | yes | yes | yes
6126 Arguments : none
6127
6128 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6129 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6130 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6131 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6132 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6133 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6134 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6135 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6136 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6137 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6138 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6139 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6140 affected.
6141
6142 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6143 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6144 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6145 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6146 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6147 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6148 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6149 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6150 latency environments.
6151
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006152 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6153
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006154
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006155option http-pretend-keepalive
6156no option http-pretend-keepalive
6157 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006159 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006160 Arguments : none
6161
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006162 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006163 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6164 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6165 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6166 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6167 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6168 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6169 consider the response complete.
6170
6171 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6172 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6173 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6174 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006175 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006176 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6177
6178 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6179 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6180 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6181 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6182 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6183 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6184 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6185
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006186 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6187 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6188 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6189 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6190 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6191 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006192
6193 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6194 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006196 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006197 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006198
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006199
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006200option http-server-close
6201no option http-server-close
6202 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6204 yes | yes | yes | yes
6205 Arguments : none
6206
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006207 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6208 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6209 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6210 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006211 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6212 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6213 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6214 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6215 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6216 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6217 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6218 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6219 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6220 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6221 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006222
6223 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6224 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6225 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6226 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006227 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6228 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006229
6230 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6231 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006232 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6233 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6234 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006235
6236 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6237 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6238
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006239 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6240 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006241
6242
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006243option http-tunnel
6244no option http-tunnel
6245 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006247 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006248 Arguments : none
6249
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006250 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6251 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6252 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6253 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006254 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006255
6256 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006257 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006258 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6259 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6260 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6261 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6262 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6263 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6264 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006265
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006266 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6267 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6268 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6269 backend.
6270
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006271 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6272 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6273
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006274 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6275 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006276
6277
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006278option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006279no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006280 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6282 yes | yes | yes | no
6283 Arguments : none
6284
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006285 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006286 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6287 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6288 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6289 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6290 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6291 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6292
6293 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6294 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006295 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6296 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6297 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006298
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006299 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6300 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6301 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6302 front of an existing proxy.
6303
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006304 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6305
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006306 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006307
6308
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006309option http-use-htx
6310no option http-use-htx
6311 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6313 yes | yes | yes | yes
6314 Arguments : none
6315
6316 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6317 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6318 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6319 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6320 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6321 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6322 representation.
6323
6324 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6325 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6326 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6327 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6328 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6329 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6330 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6331 other side's version.
6332
6333 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6334 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6335 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6336 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6337 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6338
6339 See also : "mode http"
6340
6341
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006342option httpchk
6343option httpchk <uri>
6344option httpchk <method> <uri>
6345option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6346 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6348 yes | no | yes | yes
6349 Arguments :
6350 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6351 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6352 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6353 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6354 ones.
6355
6356 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6357 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6358 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6359
6360 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6361 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6362 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6363 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6364 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6365
6366 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6367 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6368 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6369 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6370 the lack of any response.
6371
6372 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6373
6374 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6375 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6376 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6377
6378 Examples :
6379 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6380 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6381 backend https_relay
6382 mode tcp
6383 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6384 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6385
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006386 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6387 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6388 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006389
6390
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006391option httpclose
6392no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006393 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | yes | yes | yes
6396 Arguments : none
6397
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006398 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6399 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6400 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6401 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006402 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006403
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006404 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6405 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6406 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6407 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6408 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006409
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006410 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6411 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6412 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006413
6414 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6415 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006416 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006417 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6418 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6419 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006420
6421 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6422 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6423
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006424 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006425
6426
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006427option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006428 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006430 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006431 Arguments :
6432 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6433 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6434 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006435 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006436 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006437
6438 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6439 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6440 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6441 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6442 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6443 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6444 ports.
6445
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006446 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6447 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006448
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006449 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006451 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006452
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006453
6454option http_proxy
6455no option http_proxy
6456 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6458 yes | yes | yes | yes
6459 Arguments : none
6460
6461 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6462 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6463 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6464 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6465 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6466
6467 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6468 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006469 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6470 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006471
6472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6474
6475 Example :
6476 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6477 backend direct_forward
6478 option httpclose
6479 option http_proxy
6480
6481 See also : "option httpclose"
6482
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006483
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006484option independent-streams
6485no option independent-streams
6486 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6488 yes | yes | yes | yes
6489 Arguments : none
6490
6491 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6492 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6493 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6494 receive data or not.
6495
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006496 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006497 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6498 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6499 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6500 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6501 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6502 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6503 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6504 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6505 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6506 socket buffers.
6507
6508 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6509 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6510 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6511 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6512 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6513
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006514 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006515 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6516 deprecated.
6517
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006518 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006519
6520
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006521option ldap-check
6522 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6524 yes | no | yes | yes
6525 Arguments : none
6526
6527 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6528 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6529 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6530 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6531
6532 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6533 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6534
6535 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6536 configure it.
6537
6538 Example :
6539 option ldap-check
6540
6541 See also : "option httpchk"
6542
6543
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006544option external-check
6545 Use external processes for server health checks
6546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6547 yes | no | yes | yes
6548
6549 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6550 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6551 command".
6552
6553 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6554
6555 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6556
6557
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006558option log-health-checks
6559no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006560 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6562 yes | no | yes | yes
6563 Arguments : none
6564
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006565 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6566 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6567 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006568
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006569 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6570 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6571 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6572 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6573 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6574
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006575 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006576 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006577
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006578 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6579 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6580 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006581
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006582
6583option log-separate-errors
6584no option log-separate-errors
6585 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6587 yes | yes | yes | no
6588 Arguments : none
6589
6590 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6591 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6592 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6593 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6594 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6595 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6596 provides very important information.
6597
6598 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6599 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6600 error logs.
6601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006602 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006603 logging.
6604
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006605
6606option logasap
6607no option logasap
6608 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6610 yes | yes | yes | no
6611 Arguments : none
6612
6613 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6614 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6615 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6616 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6617 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6618 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6619 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006620 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006621 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6622 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6623
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006624 Examples :
6625 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6626 mode http
6627 option httplog
6628 option logasap
6629 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6630
6631 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6632 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6633 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6634 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006636 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006637 logging.
6638
6639
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006640option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006641 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6643 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006644 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006645 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6646 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006647 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006648
6649 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6650 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006651 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006652 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6653 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6654 in the MySQL table, like this :
6655
6656 USE mysql;
6657 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6658 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6659
6660 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006661 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006662 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6663 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6664 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6665 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6666 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6667 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6668 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6669
6670 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6671 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006672
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006673 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006674
6675 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6676 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6677 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6678 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006679 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6680 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006681
6682 See also: "option httpchk"
6683
6684
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006685option nolinger
6686no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006687 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006688 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6689 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006690 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006691
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006692 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006693 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6694 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6695 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6696 connections.
6697
6698 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6699 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6700 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6701 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6702 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6703 this too.
6704
6705 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6706 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6707 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6708
6709 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6710 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6711 for servers.
6712
6713 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6714 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6715
6716
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006717option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6718 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6720 yes | yes | yes | yes
6721 Arguments :
6722 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6723 matching <network>
6724 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6725 header name.
6726
6727 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6728 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6729 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6730 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6731 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6732 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6733 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6734 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6735 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6736 possible that the client has already brought one.
6737
6738 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6739 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6740 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6741 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6742 header and requires different one.
6743
6744 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6745 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6746 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6747 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6748 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6749 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6750 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6751
6752 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6753 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6754 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6755 both are defined.
6756
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006757 Examples :
6758 # Original Destination address
6759 frontend www
6760 mode http
6761 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6762
6763 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6764 backend www
6765 mode http
6766 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6767
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006768 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006769
6770
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006771option persist
6772no option persist
6773 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6774 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6775 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006776 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006777
6778 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6779 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6780 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6781 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6782 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6783 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6784 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6785 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6786 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6787 redirected to another valid server.
6788
6789 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6790 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6791
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006792 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006793
6794
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006795option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6796 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6798 yes | no | yes | yes
6799 Arguments :
6800 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6801 PostgreSQL server.
6802
6803 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6804 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6805 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6806 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6807
6808 See also: "option httpchk"
6809
6810
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006811option prefer-last-server
6812no option prefer-last-server
6813 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6814 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6815 yes | no | yes | yes
6816 Arguments : none
6817
6818 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6819 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6820 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6821 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6822 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6823 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6824 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6825 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6826 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006827 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6828 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006829 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6830 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6831 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006832 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6833 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6834 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006835
6836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6838
6839 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6840
6841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006842option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006843option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006844no option redispatch
6845 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6847 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006848 Arguments :
6849 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6850 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6851 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006852 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006853 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006854 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006855 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6856 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6857 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006859
6860 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6861 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6862 be able to access the service anymore.
6863
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006864 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6865 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006866
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006867 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006868 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6869 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006870
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006871 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6872 "redisp" keywords.
6873
6874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6876
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006877 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006878
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006879
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006880option redis-check
6881 Use redis health checks for server testing
6882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6883 yes | no | yes | yes
6884 Arguments : none
6885
6886 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6887 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6888 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6889 find the "+PONG" response message.
6890
6891 Example :
6892 option redis-check
6893
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006894 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006895
6896
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006897option smtpchk
6898option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6899 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6901 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006902 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006903 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006904 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006905 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6906
6907 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6908 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6909 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6910
6911 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6912 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6913 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6914 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6915 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6916 dead server.
6917
6918 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6919 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006920 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006921 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6922
6923 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6924 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6925 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6926 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006927 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006928
6929 Example :
6930 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6931
6932 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6933
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006935option socket-stats
6936no option socket-stats
6937
6938 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6940 yes | yes | yes | no
6941
6942 Arguments : none
6943
6944
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006945option splice-auto
6946no option splice-auto
6947 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6948 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6949 yes | yes | yes | yes
6950 Arguments : none
6951
6952 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6953 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006954 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006955 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006956 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006957 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6958 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6959 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6960 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6961
6962 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6963 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6964 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6965 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6966 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6967 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6968 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6969 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6970 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6971 keyword.
6972
6973 Example :
6974 option splice-auto
6975
6976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6978
6979 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6980 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6981
6982
6983option splice-request
6984no option splice-request
6985 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6987 yes | yes | yes | yes
6988 Arguments : none
6989
6990 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006991 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006992 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6993 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6994 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6995 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6996
6997 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6998
6999 Example :
7000 option splice-request
7001
7002 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7003 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7004
7005 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7006 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7007
7008
7009option splice-response
7010no option splice-response
7011 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7013 yes | yes | yes | yes
7014 Arguments : none
7015
7016 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007017 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007018 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7019 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7020 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7021 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7022
7023 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7024
7025 Example :
7026 option splice-response
7027
7028 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7029 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7030
7031 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7032 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7033
7034
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007035option spop-check
7036 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7038 no | no | no | yes
7039 Arguments : none
7040
7041 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7042 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7043 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7044 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7045
7046 Example :
7047 option spop-check
7048
7049 See also : "option httpchk"
7050
7051
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007052option srvtcpka
7053no option srvtcpka
7054 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7056 yes | no | yes | yes
7057 Arguments : none
7058
7059 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7060 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007061 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007062 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7063
7064 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7065 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7066 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7067 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7068
7069 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7070 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7071 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7072 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7073 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7074
7075 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7076
7077 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7078 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7079 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7080
7081 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7082 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7083
7084 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7085
7086
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007087option ssl-hello-chk
7088 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7090 yes | no | yes | yes
7091 Arguments : none
7092
7093 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7094 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7095 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7096 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7097 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7098 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7099 hello message.
7100
7101 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7102 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7103 messages, which is appreciable.
7104
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007105 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7106 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7107 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007108
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007109 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7110
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007111
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007112option tcp-check
7113 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7115 yes | no | yes | yes
7116
7117 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7118 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7119
7120 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7121 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7122 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7123
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007124 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007125 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7126 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7127 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7128 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7129 only.
7130
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007131 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007132 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7133 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7134 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7135 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7136
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007137 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007138 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7139 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007140 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007141 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7142 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7143 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7144 the respective protocols.
7145 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007146 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007147
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007148 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7149 script.
7150
7151 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7152 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7153 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7154 The "comment" is of course optional.
7155
7156
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007157 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007158 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007159 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007160 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007161
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007162 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007163 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007164 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007165
7166 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7167 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007168 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007169 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007170 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007171 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007172 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007173 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007174 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7175 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007176 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007177 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7178 tcp-check expect string +OK
7179
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007180 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007181 (send many headers before analyzing)
7182 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007183 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007184 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7185 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7186 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7187 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007188 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007189
7190
7191 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7192
7193
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007194option tcp-smart-accept
7195no option tcp-smart-accept
7196 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7198 yes | yes | yes | no
7199 Arguments : none
7200
7201 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7202 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7203 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7204 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7205 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7206 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7207
7208 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7209 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7210 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7211 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7212
7213 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7214 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7215 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007216 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007217
7218 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7219 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7220 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7221
7222 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7223 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7224 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7225
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007226 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7227
7228
7229option tcp-smart-connect
7230no option tcp-smart-connect
7231 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7233 yes | no | yes | yes
7234 Arguments : none
7235
7236 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7237 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7238 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7239 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7240 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7241
7242 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7243 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7244 complex.
7245
7246 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7247 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7248 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7249
7250 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7251 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7252
7253 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7254
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007255
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007256option tcpka
7257 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7259 yes | yes | yes | yes
7260 Arguments : none
7261
7262 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7263 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007264 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007265 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7266
7267 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7268 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7269 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7270 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7271
7272 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7273 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7274 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7275 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7276 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7277
7278 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7279
7280 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7281 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7282 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7283 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7284 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7285 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7286 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7287 backends.
7288
7289 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7290
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007291
7292option tcplog
7293 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007295 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007296 Arguments : none
7297
7298 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7299 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7300 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7301 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7302 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7303 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7304 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7305 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7306
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007307 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007309 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007310
7311
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007312option transparent
7313no option transparent
7314 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007316 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007317 Arguments : none
7318
7319 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7320 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7321 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7322 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7323 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7324 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7325 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7326 appropriate server.
7327
7328 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7329 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7330
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007331 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007332 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007333
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007334
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007335external-check command <command>
7336 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7338 yes | no | yes | yes
7339
7340 Arguments :
7341 <command> is the external command to run
7342
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007343 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7344
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007345 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007346
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007347 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7348 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7349 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7350 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7351 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7352 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007353
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007354 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7355
7356 Environment variables :
7357 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7358 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7359
7360 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7361
7362 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7363
7364 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7365 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7366 for a UNIX socket).
7367
7368 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7369
7370 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7371
7372 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7373
7374 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7375
7376 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7377
7378 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7379 socket).
7380
7381 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7382 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7383
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007384 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7385 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7386 failed.
7387
7388 Example :
7389 external-check command /bin/true
7390
7391 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7392
7393
7394external-check path <path>
7395 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7397 yes | no | yes | yes
7398
7399 Arguments :
7400 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7401
7402 The default path is "".
7403
7404 Example :
7405 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7406
7407 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7408 "external-check command"
7409
7410
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007411persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007412persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007413 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7415 yes | no | yes | yes
7416 Arguments :
7417 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007418 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7419 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007420
7421 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7422 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007423 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007424 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7425 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7426 forwarded to this server.
7427
7428 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7429 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7430 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007431 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007432 a single "listen" section.
7433
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007434 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7435 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7436 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7437
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007438 Example :
7439 listen tse-farm
7440 bind :3389
7441 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7442 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7443 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7444 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7445 persist rdp-cookie
7446 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007447 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007448 balance rdp-cookie
7449 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7450 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7451
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007452 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7453 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007454
7455
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007456rate-limit sessions <rate>
7457 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7459 yes | yes | yes | no
7460 Arguments :
7461 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7462 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7463
7464 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7465 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7466 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7467 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7468 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7469 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7470
7471 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7472 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7473 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7474 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7475
7476 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7477 listen smtp
7478 mode tcp
7479 bind :25
7480 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007481 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007482
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007483 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7484 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7485 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007486
7487 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7488
7489
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007490redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7491redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7492redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007493 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7495 no | yes | yes | yes
7496
7497 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007498 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007499
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007500 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007501 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007502 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7503 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7504 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007505
7506 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7507 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7508 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7509 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7510 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007511 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7512 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7513 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7514 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007515
7516 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7517 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7518 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7519 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7520 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7521 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007522 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007523 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007524 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7525 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7526 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007527
7528 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007529 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7530 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7531 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007532 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007533 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7534 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7535 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7536 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007537
7538 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007539 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007540
7541 - "drop-query"
7542 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7543 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7544 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7545 with a location-type redirect.
7546
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007547 - "append-slash"
7548 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7549 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7550 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7551 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7552
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007553 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7554 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7555 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7556 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7557 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7558 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7559 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7560
7561 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7562 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7563 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7564 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7565 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7566 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7567 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007568
7569 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7570 acl clear dst_port 80
7571 acl secure dst_port 8080
7572 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007573 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007574 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007575 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7576
7577 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007578 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7579 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7580 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007581 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007582
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007583 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7584 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7585 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7586
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007587 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007588 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007589
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007590 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007591 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7592 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7593 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007594
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007595 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007596
7597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007598redisp (deprecated)
7599redispatch (deprecated)
7600 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7601 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7602 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007603 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007604
7605 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7606 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7607 be able to access the service anymore.
7608
7609 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7610 redistribute them to a working server.
7611
7612 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7613 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7614 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007616 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7617 "option redispatch" instead.
7618
7619 See also : "option redispatch"
7620
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007621
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007622reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007623 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7625 no | yes | yes | yes
7626 Arguments :
7627 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7628 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007629 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007630
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007631 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7632 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7633
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007634 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7635 the last header of an HTTP request.
7636
7637 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7638 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7639 responses.
7640
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007641 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7642 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7643 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7644
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007645 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7646 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007647
7648
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007649reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7650reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007651 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 no | yes | yes | yes
7654 Arguments :
7655 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7656 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7657 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7658 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7659 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7660 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7661 ignores case.
7662
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007663 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7664 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7665
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007666 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7667 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7668 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7669 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007670 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007671
7672 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7673 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7674
7675 Example :
7676 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7677 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7678 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7679
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007680 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7681 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007682
7683
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007684reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7685reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007686 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7688 no | yes | yes | yes
7689 Arguments :
7690 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7691 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7692 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7693 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7694 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7695 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7696
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007697 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7698 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7699
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007700 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7701 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7702 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7703 next servers.
7704
7705 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7706 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7707 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7708
7709 Example :
7710 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7711 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7712 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7713
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007714 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7715 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007716
7717
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007718reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7719reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007720 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7722 no | yes | yes | yes
7723 Arguments :
7724 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7725 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7726 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7727 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7728 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7729 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7730 case.
7731
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007732 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7733 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7734
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007735 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7736 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7737 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7738 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007739 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007740
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007741 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007742 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007743 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007744
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007745 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7746 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7747
7748 Example :
7749 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7750 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7751 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7752
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007753 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7754 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007755
7756
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007757reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7758reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007759 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7761 no | yes | yes | yes
7762 Arguments :
7763 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7764 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7765 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7766 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7767 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7768 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7769 case.
7770
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007771 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7772 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7773
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007774 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7775 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7776 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7777 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7778
7779 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7780 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7781
7782 Example :
7783 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7784 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7785 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7786 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7787
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007788 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7789 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007790
7791
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007792reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7793reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007794 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7796 no | yes | yes | yes
7797 Arguments :
7798 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7799 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7800 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7801 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7802 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7803 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7804
7805 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7806 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7807 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7808 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007809 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007810
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007811 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7812 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7813
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007814 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7815 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7816 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7817
7818 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7819 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7820 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7821 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7822 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7823
7824 Example :
7825 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007826 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007827 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7828 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7829
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007830 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7831 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007832
7833
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007834reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7835reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007836 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7838 no | yes | yes | yes
7839 Arguments :
7840 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7841 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7842 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7843 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7844 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7845 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7846 ignores case.
7847
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007848 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7849 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7850
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007851 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7852 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007853 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7854 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7855 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007856 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7857 not set.
7858
7859 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7860 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7861 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7862 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7863 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7864
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007865 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007866 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007867 # block all others.
7868 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7869 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7870
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007871 # block bad guys
7872 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7873 reqitarpit . if badguys
7874
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007875 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7876 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007877
7878
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007879retries <value>
7880 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7882 yes | no | yes | yes
7883 Arguments :
7884 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7885 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7886 default value is 3.
7887
7888 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7889 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7890 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7891
7892 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007893 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7894 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007895
7896 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7897 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7898
7899 See also : "option redispatch"
7900
7901
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007902rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007903 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7905 no | yes | yes | yes
7906 Arguments :
7907 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7908 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007909 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007910
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007911 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7912 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7913
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007914 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7915 the last header of an HTTP response.
7916
7917 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7918 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7919 responses.
7920
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007921 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7922 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007923
7924
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007925rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7926rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007927 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7929 no | yes | yes | yes
7930 Arguments :
7931 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7932 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7933 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7934 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7935 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7936 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7937 ignores case.
7938
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007939 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7940 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7941
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007942 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7943 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007944 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007945 client.
7946
7947 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7948 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7949 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7950
7951 Example :
7952 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007953 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007954
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007955 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7956 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007957
7958
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007959rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7960rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007961 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 no | yes | yes | yes
7964 Arguments :
7965 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7966 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7967 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7968 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7969 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7970 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7971 ignores case.
7972
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007973 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7974 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7975
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007976 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7977 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7978 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7979 case-sensitive.
7980
7981 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007982 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7983 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7984 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007985
7986 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7987 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7988
7989 Example :
7990 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7991 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7992
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007993 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7994 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007995
7996
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007997rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7998rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007999 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 no | yes | yes | yes
8002 Arguments :
8003 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8004 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8005 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8006 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8007 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8008 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8009 ignores case.
8010
8011 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8012 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8013 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8014 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008015 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008016
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008017 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8018 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8019
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008020 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8021 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8022 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8023
8024 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8025 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8026 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8027 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8028 are not case-sensitive.
8029
8030 Example :
8031 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8032 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8033
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008034 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8035 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008036
8037
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008038server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008039 Declare a server in a backend
8040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8041 no | no | yes | yes
8042 Arguments :
8043 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008044 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008045 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008046
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008047 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8048 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8049 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8050 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008051 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8052 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8053 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8054 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8055 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008056 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8057 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8058 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8059 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8060 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8061 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8062 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008063 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008064 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8065 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8066 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8067 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8068 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8069 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008070 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8071 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008072 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8073 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008074
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008075 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008076 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8077 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8078 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8079 adding this value to the client's port.
8080
8081 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8082 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008083 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008084
8085 Examples :
8086 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8087 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008088 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008089 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8090 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8091 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008092
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008093 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8094 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8095 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8096 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8097 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8098
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008099 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8100 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008101
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008102server-state-file-name [<file>]
8103 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8104 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8105 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8106 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8107 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8108 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8109
8110 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8111 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8112
8113 global
8114 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8115
8116 backend bk
8117 load-server-state-from-file
8118
8119 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8120 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008121
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008122server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8123 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8124 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8126 no | no | yes | yes
8127
8128 Arguments:
8129 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8130
8131 <num | range>
8132 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8133 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8134 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8135 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8136
8137 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8138
8139 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8140
8141 <params*>
8142 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8143 keyword.
8144
8145 Examples:
8146 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8147 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8148 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8149
8150 # or
8151 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8152
8153 # would be equivalent to:
8154 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8155 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8156 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8157
8158
8159
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008160source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008161source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008162source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008163 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8165 yes | no | yes | yes
8166 Arguments :
8167 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8168 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008169
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008170 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008171 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8172 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8173 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8174 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8175 supported prefixes are :
8176 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8177 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8178 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008179 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008180 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8181 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008182
8183 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8184 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008185 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8186 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8187 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008188
8189 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8190 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8191 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8192 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8193 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8194 <addr>.
8195
8196 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8197 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8198 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8199 port.
8200
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008201 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8202 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8203 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8204 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008205 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008206 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8207 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8208 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8209 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8210 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8211 HTTP header.
8212
8213 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8214 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008215 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008216 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8217 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8218 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8219 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8220 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8221 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8222 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8223
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008224 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8225 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8226 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8227 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8228 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8229 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8230
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008231 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8232 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8233 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8234 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8235
8236 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8237 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8238 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8239 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8240 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8241 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8242
8243 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8244 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8245 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8246 there are two methods :
8247
8248 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8249 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8250 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8251 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8252 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8253 of the client ranges may be used.
8254
8255 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8256 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8257 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8258 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8259 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8260 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8261 same session.
8262
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008263 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8264 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8265 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008266 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008267
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008268 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8269
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008270 Examples :
8271 backend private
8272 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8273 source 192.168.1.200
8274
8275 backend transparent_ssl1
8276 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8277 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8278
8279 backend transparent_ssl2
8280 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8281 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8282 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8283
8284 backend transparent_ssl3
8285 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8286 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8287 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8288
8289 backend transparent_smtp
8290 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8291 # with Tproxy version 4.
8292 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8293
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008294 backend transparent_http
8295 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8296 # proxy.
8297 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008299 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008300 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008302
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008303srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8304 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8306 yes | no | yes | yes
8307 Arguments :
8308 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8309 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8310 as explained at the top of this document.
8311
8312 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8313 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8314 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8315 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8316 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8317 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8318 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8319
8320 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8321 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8322 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8323 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8324 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008325 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008326 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008327 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008328
8329 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8330 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8331 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8332 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8333 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8334 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8335
8336 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8337 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8338
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008339 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8340 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008341
8342
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008343stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8344 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008346 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008347
8348 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8349 matched.
8350
8351 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8352 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8353
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008354 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8355 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008356 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008357
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008358 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8359 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8360 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8361 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008362
8363 Example :
8364 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8365 backend stats_localhost
8366 stats enable
8367 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8368
8369 Example :
8370 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8371 backend stats_auth
8372 stats enable
8373 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8374 stats admin if TRUE
8375
8376 Example :
8377 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8378 userlist stats-auth
8379 group admin users admin
8380 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8381 group readonly users haproxy
8382 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8383
8384 backend stats_auth
8385 stats enable
8386 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8387 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8388 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8389 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8390
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008391 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8392 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8393 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008394
8395
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008396stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8397 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008399 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008400 Arguments :
8401 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8402
8403 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8404
8405 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8406 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8407 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8408 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8409 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8410 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8411
8412 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8413 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8414 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008415 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008416
8417 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8418 report using "stats scope".
8419
8420 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8421 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8422 unobvious parameters.
8423
8424 Example :
8425 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8426 backend public_www
8427 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8428 stats enable
8429 stats hide-version
8430 stats scope .
8431 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008432 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008433 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8434 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8435
8436 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8437 backend private_monitoring
8438 stats enable
8439 stats uri /admin?stats
8440 stats refresh 5s
8441
8442 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8443
8444
8445stats enable
8446 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008448 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008449 Arguments : none
8450
8451 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8452 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8453 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8454 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8455 - stats auth : no authentication
8456 - stats scope : no restriction
8457
8458 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8459 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8460 unobvious parameters.
8461
8462 Example :
8463 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8464 backend public_www
8465 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8466 stats enable
8467 stats hide-version
8468 stats scope .
8469 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008470 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008471 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8472 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8473
8474 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8475 backend private_monitoring
8476 stats enable
8477 stats uri /admin?stats
8478 stats refresh 5s
8479
8480 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8481
8482
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008483stats hide-version
8484 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008486 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008487 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008488
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008489 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8490 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8491 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8492 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8493 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8494 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008495
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008496 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8497 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8498 unobvious parameters.
8499
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008500 Example :
8501 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8502 backend public_www
8503 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008504 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008505 stats hide-version
8506 stats scope .
8507 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008508 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008509 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8510 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008511
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008512 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8513 backend private_monitoring
8514 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008515 stats uri /admin?stats
8516 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008517
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008518 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008519
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008520
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008521stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8522 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8523 Access control for statistics
8524
8525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8526 no | no | yes | yes
8527
8528 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8529 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8530 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8531 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8532 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8533 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8534
8535 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8536 instance.
8537
8538 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8539 about ACL usage.
8540
8541
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008542stats realm <realm>
8543 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008545 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008546 Arguments :
8547 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8548 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8549 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8550
8551 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8552 using a backslash ('\').
8553
8554 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8555 only related to authentication.
8556
8557 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8558 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8559 unobvious parameters.
8560
8561 Example :
8562 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8563 backend public_www
8564 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8565 stats enable
8566 stats hide-version
8567 stats scope .
8568 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008569 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008570 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8571 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8572
8573 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8574 backend private_monitoring
8575 stats enable
8576 stats uri /admin?stats
8577 stats refresh 5s
8578
8579 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8580
8581
8582stats refresh <delay>
8583 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008585 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008586 Arguments :
8587 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8588 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8589 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8590 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8591 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8592 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8593
8594 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8595 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8596 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8597 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8598
8599 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8600 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8601 unobvious parameters.
8602
8603 Example :
8604 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8605 backend public_www
8606 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8607 stats enable
8608 stats hide-version
8609 stats scope .
8610 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008611 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008612 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8613 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8614
8615 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8616 backend private_monitoring
8617 stats enable
8618 stats uri /admin?stats
8619 stats refresh 5s
8620
8621 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8622
8623
8624stats scope { <name> | "." }
8625 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008627 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008628 Arguments :
8629 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8630 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8631 section in which the statement appears.
8632
8633 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8634 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8635 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8636 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8637 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8638 exists.
8639
8640 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8641 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8642 unobvious parameters.
8643
8644 Example :
8645 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8646 backend public_www
8647 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8648 stats enable
8649 stats hide-version
8650 stats scope .
8651 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008652 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008653 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8654 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8655
8656 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8657 backend private_monitoring
8658 stats enable
8659 stats uri /admin?stats
8660 stats refresh 5s
8661
8662 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8663
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008664
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008665stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008666 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008668 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008669
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008670 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008671 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8672
8673 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8674 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8675
8676 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8677 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008678 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008679
8680 Example :
8681 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8682 backend private_monitoring
8683 stats enable
8684 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8685 stats uri /admin?stats
8686 stats refresh 5s
8687
8688 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8689 global section.
8690
8691
8692stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008693 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8695 yes | yes | yes | yes
8696 Arguments : none
8697
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008698 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008699 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8700 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8701 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8702 - IP (socket, server)
8703 - cookie (backend, server)
8704
8705 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8706 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008707 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008708
8709 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8710
8711
8712stats show-node [ <name> ]
8713 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008715 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008716 Arguments:
8717 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8718 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8719
8720 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8721 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008722 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008723
8724 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8725 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8726 unobvious parameters.
8727
8728 Example:
8729 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8730 backend private_monitoring
8731 stats enable
8732 stats show-node Europe-1
8733 stats uri /admin?stats
8734 stats refresh 5s
8735
8736 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8737 section.
8738
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008739
8740stats uri <prefix>
8741 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008743 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008744 Arguments :
8745 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8746 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8747 query string.
8748
8749 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8750 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8751 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8752 possible to reach it in the application.
8753
8754 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008755 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008756 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8757 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8758 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8759 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8760
8761 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8762 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8763 an address or a port to statistics only.
8764
8765 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8766 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8767 unobvious parameters.
8768
8769 Example :
8770 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8771 backend public_www
8772 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8773 stats enable
8774 stats hide-version
8775 stats scope .
8776 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008777 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008778 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8779 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8780
8781 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8782 backend private_monitoring
8783 stats enable
8784 stats uri /admin?stats
8785 stats refresh 5s
8786
8787 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8788
8789
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008790stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8791 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008793 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008794
8795 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008796 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008797 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008798 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008799 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8800
8801 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8802 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8803 the "stick-table" statement.
8804
8805 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8806 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8807 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8808 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8809 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8810
8811 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8812 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8813 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8814 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8815 transformation rules.
8816
8817 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8818 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8819 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8820 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8821 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8822 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8823 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8824
8825 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8826 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8827 ACL based conditions.
8828
8829 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8830 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8831 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8832 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8833
8834 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8835 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8836 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8837 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8838
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008839 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8840 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008841 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008842
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008843 Example :
8844 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8845 # last 30 minutes
8846 backend pop
8847 mode tcp
8848 balance roundrobin
8849 stick store-request src
8850 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8851 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8852 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8853
8854 backend smtp
8855 mode tcp
8856 balance roundrobin
8857 stick match src table pop
8858 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8859 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8860
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008861 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008862 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008863
8864
8865stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8866 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8868 no | no | yes | yes
8869
8870 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8871 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8872 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8873 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8874
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008875 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8876 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008877 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008878
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008879 Examples :
8880 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008881 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008882
8883 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8884 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8885 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8886
8887
8888 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8889 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8890 backend http
8891 mode http
8892 balance roundrobin
8893 stick on src table https
8894 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8895 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8896 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8897
8898 backend https
8899 mode tcp
8900 balance roundrobin
8901 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8902 stick on src
8903 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8904 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8905
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008906 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008907
8908
8909stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8910 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8912 no | no | yes | yes
8913
8914 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008915 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008916 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008917 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008918 server is selected.
8919
8920 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8921 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8922 the "stick-table" statement.
8923
8924 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8925 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8926 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8927 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8928 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8929 address.
8930
8931 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8932 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8933 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8934 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8935 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8936 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8937 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8938 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8939 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8940 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8941
8942 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8943 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8944 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8945 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8946 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8947 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8948 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8949
8950 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8951 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8952 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8953 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8954
8955 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8956 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8957 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8958 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8959 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8960 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008961 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8962 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8963 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8964 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8965 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8966 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008967
8968 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8969 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8970 the request.
8971
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008972 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8973 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008974 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008975
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008976 Example :
8977 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8978 # last 30 minutes
8979 backend pop
8980 mode tcp
8981 balance roundrobin
8982 stick store-request src
8983 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8984 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8985 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8986
8987 backend smtp
8988 mode tcp
8989 balance roundrobin
8990 stick match src table pop
8991 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8992 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8993
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008994 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008995 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008996
8997
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008998stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008999 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9000 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009001 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009003 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009004
9005 Arguments :
9006 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9007 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9008 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9009 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9010
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009011 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9012 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9013 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9014 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9015
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009016 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9017 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9018 instance.
9019
9020 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9021 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9022 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9023 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9024 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9025 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009026 to 32 characters.
9027
9028 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9029 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9030 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009031 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009032 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9033 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009034
9035 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009036 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9037 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009038 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9039 increase.
9040
9041 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009042 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9043 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9044 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009045
9046 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9047 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9048 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9049 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009050 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009051 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9052 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9053 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9054 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9055 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9056 parameter (see below).
9057
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009058 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9059 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9060 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9061 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9062 soft restart.
9063
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009064 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9065 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009066
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009067 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9068 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9069 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9070 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009071 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009072 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009073 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9074 if not expiration delay is specified.
9075
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009076 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9077 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9078 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9079 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009080 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9081 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9082 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9083 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9084 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9085 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9086 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9087 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9088 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9089 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9090 types and their arguments.
9091
9092 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9093 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9094 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9095 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9096
9097 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9098 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9099 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009100 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009101
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009102 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9103 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9104 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009105 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009106 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009107 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009108
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009109 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9110 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9111 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9112 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9113
9114 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9115 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9116 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9117 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9118 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9119 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9120
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009121 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9122 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9123 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9124 they were received.
9125
9126 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9127 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9128 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9129 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9130 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9131
9132 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9133 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9134 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9135 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9136 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9137
9138 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9139 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9140 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9141
9142 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9143 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9144 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9145 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9146 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9147
9148 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9149 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9150 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9151 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9152 the client side.
9153
9154 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9155 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9156 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9157 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9158 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9159 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9160 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9161
9162 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9163 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9164 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9165 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9166 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9167 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009168 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009169
9170 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9171 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9172 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9173 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9174 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9175 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9176
9177 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009178 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009179 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9180 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9181
9182 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9183 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9184 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9185 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9186 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9187 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9188 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9189 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9190 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9191 recommended for better fairness.
9192
9193 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009194 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009195 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9196 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9197
9198 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9199 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9200 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9201 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9202 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9203 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9204 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9205 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9206 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9207 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009208
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009209 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9210 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009211 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9212 reference it.
9213
9214 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9215 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009216 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9217 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9218 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009219
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009220 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9221 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9222 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9223 something that can be ignored.
9224
9225 Example:
9226 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9227 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9228 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9229 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9230
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009231 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009232 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009233
9234
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009235stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009236 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9238 no | no | yes | yes
9239
9240 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009241 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009242 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009243 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009244 server is selected.
9245
9246 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9247 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9248 the "stick-table" statement.
9249
9250 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9251 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9252 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9253 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9254
9255 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9256 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9257 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9258 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9259 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9260 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009261 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009262 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9263 rules.
9264
9265 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9266 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9267 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9268 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9269 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9270 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9271 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9272
9273 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9274 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9275 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9276 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9277
9278 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9279 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9280 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9281 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9282 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9283 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009284 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9285 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9286 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9287 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9288 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9289 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9290 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9291 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9292 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009293
9294 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9295
9296 Example :
9297 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9298 backend https
9299 mode tcp
9300 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009301 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009302 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009303
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009304 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9305 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9306
9307 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9308 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9309 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9310
9311 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9312 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009313
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009314 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9315 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9316 # at offset 44.
9317
9318 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9319 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9320
9321 # Learn on response if server hello.
9322 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009323
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009324 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9325 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9326
9327 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9328 extraction.
9329
9330
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009331tcp-check connect [params*]
9332 Opens a new connection
9333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9334 no | no | yes | yes
9335
9336 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9337 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9338 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9339
9340 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9341 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9342 of the sequence.
9343
9344 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9345 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9346 do.
9347
9348 Parameters :
9349 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9350 use the TCP connection.
9351
9352 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9353 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9354 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9355
9356 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9357
9358 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9359
9360 Examples:
9361 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9362 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9363 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9364 option tcp-check
9365 tcp-check connect
9366 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9367 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9368 tcp-check send \r\n
9369 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9370 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9371 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9372 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9373 tcp-check send \r\n
9374 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9375 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9376
9377 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9378 option tcp-check
9379 tcp-check connect port 110
9380 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9381 tcp-check connect port 143
9382 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9383 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9384
9385 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9386
9387
9388tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009389 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009390 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9391 no | no | yes | yes
9392
9393 Arguments :
9394 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9395 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9396 binary.
9397 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9398 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9399 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9400
9401 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9402 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9403 with the usual backslash ('\').
9404 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009405 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009406 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9407 used upper or lower case.
9408
9409
9410 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9411
9412 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9413 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9414 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9415 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9416 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9417 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9418 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9419 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9420
9421 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9422 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9423 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9424 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9425 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9426 expression.
9427
9428 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9429 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9430 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9431 this exact hexadecimal string.
9432 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9433
9434 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9435 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9436 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9437 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9438 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9439 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9440 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9441 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9442 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9443 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9444 the null character.
9445
9446 Examples :
9447 # perform a POP check
9448 option tcp-check
9449 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9450
9451 # perform an IMAP check
9452 option tcp-check
9453 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9454
9455 # look for the redis master server
9456 option tcp-check
9457 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009458 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009459 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9460 tcp-check expect string role:master
9461 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9462 tcp-check expect string +OK
9463
9464
9465 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9466 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9467
9468
9469tcp-check send <data>
9470 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9472 no | no | yes | yes
9473
9474 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9475 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9476
9477 Examples :
9478 # look for the redis master server
9479 option tcp-check
9480 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9481 tcp-check expect string role:master
9482
9483 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9484 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9485
9486
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009487tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9488 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009489 tcp health check
9490 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9491 no | no | yes | yes
9492
9493 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9494 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009495 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009496 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9497 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9498 hexadecimal string.
9499 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9500
9501 Examples :
9502 # redis check in binary
9503 option tcp-check
9504 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9505 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9506
9507
9508 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9509 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9510
9511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009512tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9513 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9515 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009516 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009517 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9518 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009520 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009521
9522 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9523 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009524 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9525 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9526 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9527 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9528 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9529 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009530
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009531 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9532 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9533 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9534 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009535
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009536 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009537 - accept :
9538 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9539 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9540 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009541
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009542 - reject :
9543 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9544 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9545 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9546 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9547 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9548 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9549 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9550 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9551 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9552 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9553 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009554 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009555
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009556 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9557 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9558 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9559 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9560 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9561 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9562 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9563 hosts.
9564
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009565 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9566 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9567 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9568 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9569 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9570 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9571 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9572 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9573
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009574 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9575 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9576 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9577 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9578 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9579 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9580 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9581 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9582 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009583 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9584 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009585
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009586 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009587 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009588 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9589 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9590 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9591 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9592 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9593 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9594 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9595 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9596 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9597 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9598 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9599 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009600
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009601 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009602 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009603 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009604 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009605 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9606 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9607 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009608
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009609 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9610 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9611 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9612 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009613
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009614 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9615 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9616 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9617 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9618 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009619 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9620 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9621 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9622 layer7 information is extracted.
9623
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009624 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9625 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9626 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9627 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9628 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009629
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009630 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9631 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9632 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9633 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9634
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009635 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9636 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9637 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9638 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9639
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009640 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9641 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9642 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9643 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9644 continues.
9645
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009646 - set-src <expr> :
9647 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9648 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9649 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009650 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009651
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009652 Arguments:
9653 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9654 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009655
9656 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009657 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9658
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009659 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9660 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009661
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009662 - set-src-port <expr> :
9663 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9664 expression.
9665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009666 Arguments:
9667 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9668 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009669
9670 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009671 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9672
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009673 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9674 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9675 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009676
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009677 - set-dst <expr> :
9678 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9679 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9680 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9681 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9682 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9683
9684 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9685 followed by some converters.
9686
9687 Example:
9688
9689 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9690 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9691
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009692 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9693 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9694
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009695 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9696 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9697 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9698 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9699
9700
9701 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9702 followed by some converters.
9703
9704 Example:
9705
9706 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9707
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009708 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9709 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9710 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9711
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009712 - "silent-drop" :
9713 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009714 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009715 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9716 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9717 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9718 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9719 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009720 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9721 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009722 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9723 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009724 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009725 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9726 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9727 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9728 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9729
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009730 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9731 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9732 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009733
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009734 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9735 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9736 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009737
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009738 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009739 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009740 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009741
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009742 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9743 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9744 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009745
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009746 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009747 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9748 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009749
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009750 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9751
9752 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9753
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009754 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9755
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009756 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009757
9758
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009759tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9760 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009762 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009763 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009764 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9765 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009766
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009767 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009768
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009769 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009770 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9771 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9772 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9773 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009774
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009775 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9776 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9777 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9778 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009779 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9780 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9781 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9782 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9783 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9784 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009785 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009786 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009787
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009788 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9789 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9790 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9791 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009792
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009793 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009794 - accept : the request is accepted
9795 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9796 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009797 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009798 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009799 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009800 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009801 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009802 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009803 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009804 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009805 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009806
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009807 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9808 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009809
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009810 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9811 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9812 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9813 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9814 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9815 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009817 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009818 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9819 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009820
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009821 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009822 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9823 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9824 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9825 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009826 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9827 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9828 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009829
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009830 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009831 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9832 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9833 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009834
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009835 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009836 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9837 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009838
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009839 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9840 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009841 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009842 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9843 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009844 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009845 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009846 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009847 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9848 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009849 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009850 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9851 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009852
9853 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9854 followed by some converters.
9855
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009856 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9857 <var-name>.
9858
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009859 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9860 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9861 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9862 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9863 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9864
9865 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9866 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9867 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9868 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9869 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9870 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9871 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9872 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9873 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9874 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9875 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9876
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009877 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9878 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9879 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9880 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9881 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9882
9883 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9884
9885 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9886
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009887 Example:
9888
9889 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009890 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009891
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009892 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009893 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9894 # and reject everything else.
9895 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9896 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009897 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009898 tcp-request content reject
9899
9900 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009901 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9902 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9903 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009904 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009905
9906 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9907 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9908 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009909 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009910 tcp-request content reject
9911
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009912 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009913 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009914 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009915 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009916 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9917 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009918
9919 Example:
9920 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9921 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009922 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009924 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009925 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009926
9927 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009928 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009929 # protecting all our sites
9930 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009931 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9932 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009933 ...
9934 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9935
9936 backend http_dynamic
9937 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009938 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009939 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009940 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009941 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009942 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009943 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009945 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009946
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009947 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9948 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009949
9950
9951tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9952 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009954 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009955 Arguments :
9956 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9957 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9958 as explained at the top of this document.
9959
9960 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9961 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9962 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9963 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9964 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9965
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009966 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9967 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9968 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9969 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9970
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009971 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9972 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009973 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009974 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009975 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9976 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9977 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9978 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009979
9980 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9981 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9982 it pass through unaffected.
9983
9984 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9985 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9986 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009987 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009988 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9989 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009990 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9991 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9992 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009993
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009994 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009995 "timeout client".
9996
9997
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009998tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9999 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10001 no | no | yes | yes
10002 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010003 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10004 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010005
10006 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10007
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010008 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010009 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10010 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010011 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10012 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010013
10014 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10015
10016 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10017 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10018 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10019 inserted.
10020
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010021 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010022 - accept :
10023 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10024 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10025 the rules evaluation.
10026
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010027 - close :
10028 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10029 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10030 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10031 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10032 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10033 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010034 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010035 protocols.
10036
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010037 - reject :
10038 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10039 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010040 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010041
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010042 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10043 Sets a variable.
10044
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010045 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10046 Unsets a variable.
10047
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010048 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10049 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10050 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10051 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10052
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010053 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10054 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10055 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10056 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10057
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010058 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10059 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10060 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10061 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10062 continues.
10063
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010064 - "silent-drop" :
10065 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010066 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010067 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10068 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10069 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10070 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10071 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010072 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10073 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010074 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10075 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010076 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010077 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10078 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10079 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10080 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10081
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010082 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10083 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10084
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010085 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10086 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10087 for changing the default action to a reject.
10088
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010089 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10090 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10091 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10092 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010093 period.
10094
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010095 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10096 declared inline.
10097
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010098 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10099 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010100 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010101 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10102 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010103 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010104 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010105 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010106 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10107 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010108 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010109 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10110 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010111
10112 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10113 followed by some converters.
10114
10115 Example:
10116
10117 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10118
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010119 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10120 <var-name>.
10121
10122 Example:
10123
10124 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10125
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010126 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10127 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10128 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10129 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10130 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10131
10132 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10133
10134 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10135
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010136 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10137
10138 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10139
10140
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010141tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10142 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10144 no | yes | yes | no
10145 Arguments :
10146 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10147 below.
10148
10149 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10150
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010151 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010152 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10153 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10154 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10155 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10156 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10157 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10158 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010159 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010160 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10161 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10162 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10163 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10164 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10165 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10166 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10167 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10168 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10169 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10170 instead.
10171
10172 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10173 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10174 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10175 rules which may be inserted.
10176
10177 Several types of actions are supported :
10178 - accept : the request is accepted
10179 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10180 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10181 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010182 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010183 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10184 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010185 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010186 - silent-drop
10187
10188 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10189 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10190 sections for a complete description.
10191
10192 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10193 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10194 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10195
10196 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10197 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10198 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10199 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10200 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10201
10202 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10203 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10204
10205 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10206 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10207 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10208
10209 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10210 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10211 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10212
10213 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10214 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10215 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10216
10217 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10218 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10219 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10220
10221 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10222
10223 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10224
10225
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010226tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10227 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10229 no | no | yes | yes
10230 Arguments :
10231 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10232 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10233 as explained at the top of this document.
10234
10235 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10236
10237
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010238timeout check <timeout>
10239 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10240 established.
10241
10242 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10243 yes | no | yes | yes
10244 Arguments:
10245 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10246 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10247 as explained at the top of this document.
10248
10249 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10250 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010251 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010252 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010253 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10254 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10255 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010256
10257 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10258 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10259
10260 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10261 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010262 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010263
10264 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10265 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10266 forget about it.
10267
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010268 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10269 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010270
10271
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010272timeout client <timeout>
10273timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10274 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10276 yes | yes | yes | no
10277 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010278 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010279 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10280 as explained at the top of this document.
10281
10282 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10283 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10284 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010285 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10286 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10287 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10288 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010289 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10290 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10291 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010292 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010293 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010294 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10295 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010296 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10297 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010298
10299 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10300 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10301 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10302 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10303 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10304 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10305
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010306 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010307
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010308 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10309 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10310 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10311
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010312 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10313 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010314
10315
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010316timeout client-fin <timeout>
10317 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10319 yes | yes | yes | no
10320 Arguments :
10321 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10322 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10323 as explained at the top of this document.
10324
10325 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10326 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10327 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10328 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10329 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10330 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10331 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010332 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10333 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10334 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010335
10336 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10337 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10338 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10339
10340 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10341
10342
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010343timeout connect <timeout>
10344timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10345 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10347 yes | no | yes | yes
10348 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010349 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010350 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10351 as explained at the top of this document.
10352
10353 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010354 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010355 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010356 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010357 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10358 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010359
10360 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10361 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10362 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10363 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10364 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10365 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10366
10367 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10368 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10369 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10370
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010371 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10372 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010373
10374
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010375timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10376 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10378 yes | yes | yes | yes
10379 Arguments :
10380 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10381 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10382 as explained at the top of this document.
10383
10384 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10385 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10386 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10387 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10388 once the request has started to present itself.
10389
10390 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10391 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10392 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10393 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10394 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10395
10396 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10397 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10398 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10399 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10400
10401 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10402 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010403 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010404 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10405 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010406 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010407
10408 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10409 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10410 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10411 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10412
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010413 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10414 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010415 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10416
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010417 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10418
10419
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010420timeout http-request <timeout>
10421 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010423 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010424 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010425 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010426 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10427 as explained at the top of this document.
10428
10429 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10430 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10431 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10432 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10433 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10434 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10435 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010436 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10437 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10438 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10439 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010440 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010441 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10442 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010443
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010444 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10445 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10446 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10447 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10448 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010449 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010450
10451 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10452 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010453 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010454 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10455 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10456
10457 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010458 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10459 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10460 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010461
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010462 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010463 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010464
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010465
10466timeout queue <timeout>
10467 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10469 yes | no | yes | yes
10470 Arguments :
10471 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10472 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10473 as explained at the top of this document.
10474
10475 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10476 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10477 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10478 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10479 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10480
10481 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10482 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10483 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10484 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10485
10486 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10487
10488
10489timeout server <timeout>
10490timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10491 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10493 yes | no | yes | yes
10494 Arguments :
10495 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10496 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10497 as explained at the top of this document.
10498
10499 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10500 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10501 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10502 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10503 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10504 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10505 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10506
10507 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10508 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10509 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10510 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10511 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010512 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010513 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010514 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10515 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010516 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10517 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010518
10519 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10520 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10521 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10522 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10523 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10524 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10525
10526 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10527 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10528 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10529
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010530 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010531
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010532
10533timeout server-fin <timeout>
10534 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10536 yes | no | yes | yes
10537 Arguments :
10538 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10539 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10540 as explained at the top of this document.
10541
10542 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10543 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10544 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10545 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10546 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10547 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10548 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10549 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10550 situations, it should not be needed.
10551
10552 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10553 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10554 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10555
10556 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10557
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010558
10559timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010560 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10562 yes | yes | yes | yes
10563 Arguments :
10564 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10565 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10566 as explained at the top of this document.
10567
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010568 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10569 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10570 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10571 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010572
10573 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10574 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10575 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10576 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010577 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010578
10579 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10580
10581
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010582timeout tunnel <timeout>
10583 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10585 yes | no | yes | yes
10586 Arguments :
10587 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10588 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10589 as explained at the top of this document.
10590
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010591 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010592 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10593 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10594 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010595 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10596 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010597 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10598 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10599 specified.
10600
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010601 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10602 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10603 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10604 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10605 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10606 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10607 state.
10608
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010609 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10610 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10611 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10612 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010613 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010614
10615 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10616 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10617 forget about it.
10618
10619 Example :
10620 defaults http
10621 option http-server-close
10622 timeout connect 5s
10623 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010624 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010625 timeout server 30s
10626 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10627
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010628 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010629
10630
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010631transparent (deprecated)
10632 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010634 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010635 Arguments : none
10636
10637 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10638 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10639 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10640 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10641 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10642 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10643 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10644 appropriate server.
10645
10646 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10647
10648 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10649 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10650
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010651 See also: "option transparent"
10652
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010653unique-id-format <string>
10654 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10656 yes | yes | yes | no
10657 Arguments :
10658 <string> is a log-format string.
10659
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010660 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10661 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10662 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10663 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010664
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010665 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10666 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10667 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10668 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10669 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10670 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10671 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10672 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010673
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010674 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10675 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010676
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010677 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010678
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010679 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010680
10681 will generate:
10682
10683 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10684
10685 See also: "unique-id-header"
10686
10687unique-id-header <name>
10688 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10690 yes | yes | yes | no
10691 Arguments :
10692 <name> is the name of the header.
10693
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010694 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10695 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010696
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010697 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010698
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010699 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010700 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10701
10702 will generate:
10703
10704 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10705
10706 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010707
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010708use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010709 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10711 no | yes | yes | no
10712 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010713 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10714 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010715
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010716 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10717 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010718
10719 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10720 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10721 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010722 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010723 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010724 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10725 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010726
10727 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10728 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10729 assign the backend.
10730
10731 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10732 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10733 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10734 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10735 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10736 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10737
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010738 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010739 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010740 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10741 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10742 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10743
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010744 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10745 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10746 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10747 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10748 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10749 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10750 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10751 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10752 cannot be forced from the request.
10753
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010754 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010755 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10756 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10757
10758 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10759 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010760
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010761
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010762use-server <server> if <condition>
10763use-server <server> unless <condition>
10764 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10766 no | no | yes | yes
10767 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010768 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010769
10770 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10771
10772 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10773 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10774 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10775
10776 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10777 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10778 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10779 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10780 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10781 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10782 matches will assign the server.
10783
10784 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10785 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10786 with the next rules until one matches.
10787
10788 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10789 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10790 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10791 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10792
10793 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10794 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10795 stripped.
10796
10797 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10798 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10799 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10800 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10801
10802 Example :
10803 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10804 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10805 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10806 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10807 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10808 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010809 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010810 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10811 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10812
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010813 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010814
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010815
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100108165. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010817--------------------------
10818
10819The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10820depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10821settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10822written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10823described in this section.
10824
10825
108265.1. Bind options
10827-----------------
10828
10829The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10830as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10831no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10832parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10833while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10834provided immediately after the setting name.
10835
10836The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10837
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010838accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10839 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10840 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10841 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10842 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10843 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10844 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10845 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10846 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10847 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010848 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10849 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10850 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010851
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010852accept-proxy
10853 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010854 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10855 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010856 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10857 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10858 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10859 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010860 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010861 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10862 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010863 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10864 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010865
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010866allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010867 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010868 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10869 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10870 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10871 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010872
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010873alpn <protocols>
10874 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10875 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10876 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10877 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10878 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010879 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10880 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10881 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10882 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10883 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10884 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10885 preference, like below :
10886
10887 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010888
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010889backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010890 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010891 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10892
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010893curves <curves>
10894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10895 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10896 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10897 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10898 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10899 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10900
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010901ecdhe <named curve>
10902 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010903 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10904 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010905
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010906ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10908 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10909 client's certificate.
10910
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010911ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10913 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10914 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10915 error is ignored.
10916
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010917ca-sign-file <cafile>
10918 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10919 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10920 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10921 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10922 'generate-certificates' for details.
10923
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010924ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10926 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10927 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10928 'generate-certificates' for details.
10929
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010930ciphers <ciphers>
10931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10932 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010933 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010934 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010935 information and recommendations see e.g.
10936 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10937 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10938 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10939
10940ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10942 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10943 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10944 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010945 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10946 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010947
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010948crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010949 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10950 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10951 to verify client's certificate.
10952
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010953crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10955 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10956 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10957 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10958 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10959 file.
10960
10961 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10962 are loaded.
10963
10964 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010965 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010966 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10967 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10968 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10969 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010970 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10971 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010972 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010973
10974 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10975 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10976 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10977 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010978 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10979 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010980
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010981 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010982
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010983 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010984 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010985 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10986 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010987 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10988 clients).
10989
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010990 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10991 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10992 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10993 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10994 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10995 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10996 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10997 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10998 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10999 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11000 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11001 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11002 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11003
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011004 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11005 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11006 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11007 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11008 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11009
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011010 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11011 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11012 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11013 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011014
11015 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11016 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11017 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11018 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11019 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11020 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11021 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11022 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11023 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11024
11025 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11026
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011027 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011028 a cert bundle.
11029
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011030 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011031 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11032 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11033 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11034 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11035 provide multi-cert support.
11036
11037 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11038
11039 Filename | CN | SAN
11040 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11041 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011042 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011043 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11044 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11045
11046 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11047 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11048 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11049 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011050 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11051 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11052 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011053
11054 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11055 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11056
11057 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11058 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11059 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11060
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011061crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011062 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011063 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011064 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011065 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011066
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011067crt-list <file>
11068 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011069 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11070 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011071
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011072 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11073
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011074 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11075 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011076 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011077 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011078
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011079 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11080 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11081 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11082 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11083 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11084 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11085 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11086 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011087
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011088 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011089 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011090 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11091 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11092 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011093
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011094 crt-list file example:
11095 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011096 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011097 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011098 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011099
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011100defer-accept
11101 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11102 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11103 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011104 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011105 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11106 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11107 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11108 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11109 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11110 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11111 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11112
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011113expose-fd listeners
11114 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11115 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011116 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11117 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011118 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011119
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011120force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011121 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011122 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011123 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011124 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011125
11126force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011127 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011128 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011129 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011130
11131force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011132 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011133 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011134 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011135
11136force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011137 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011138 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011139 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011140
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011141force-tlsv13
11142 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11143 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011144 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011145
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011146generate-certificates
11147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11148 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11149 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11150 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11151 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11152 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11153 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11154 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11155 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11156 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11157 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11158
11159 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11160 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011161 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011162 certificate is used many times.
11163
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011164gid <gid>
11165 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11166 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11167 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11168 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11169 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11170
11171group <group>
11172 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11173 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11174 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11175 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11176 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11177
11178id <id>
11179 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11180 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11181 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11182 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11183
11184interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011185 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11186 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11187 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11188 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11189 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11190 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011191 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11192 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11193 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11194 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11195 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11196 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011197
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011198level <level>
11199 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11200 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11201 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011202 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011203 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11204 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11205 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011206 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011207 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011208 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011209 all counters).
11210
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011211severity-output <format>
11212 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11213 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11214 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11215 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11216 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11217 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11218 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11219 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11220 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11221 rfc5424 convention.
11222
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011223maxconn <maxconn>
11224 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11225 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11226 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11227 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11228 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11229 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11230 eat all memory.
11231
11232mode <mode>
11233 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11234 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11235 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11236 UNIX sockets.
11237
11238mss <maxseg>
11239 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11240 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11241 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11242 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11243 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11244 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11245 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11246 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11247 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11248 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11249 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11250
11251name <name>
11252 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11253 page.
11254
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011255namespace <name>
11256 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11257 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11258 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11259 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11260
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011261nice <nice>
11262 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11263 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11264 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11265 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11266 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11267 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11268 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11269 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11270 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11271 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11272 one for an RDP socket.
11273
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011274no-ca-names
11275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11276 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11277
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011278no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011280 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011281 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011282 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011283 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11284 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011285
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011286no-tls-tickets
11287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11288 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11289 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011290 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11291 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011292
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011293no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011295 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011296 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011297 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011298 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11299 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011300
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011301no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011302 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011303 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011304 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011305 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011306 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11307 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011308
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011309no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011311 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011312 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011313 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011314 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11315 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011316
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011317no-tlsv13
11318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11319 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11320 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11321 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011322 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11323 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011324
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011325npn <protocols>
11326 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11327 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11328 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11329 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011330 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011331 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11332 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11333 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11334 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11335 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011336
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011337prefer-client-ciphers
11338 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11339 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11340 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011341 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11342 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11343 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011344
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011345process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011346 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011347 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011348 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011349 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11350 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11351 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11352 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011353 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011354 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11355 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11356 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11357 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11358 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011359
11360 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11361
11362 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11363 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11364 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11365 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11366 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11367 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11368 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11369 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011370
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011371proto <name>
11372 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11373 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11374 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11375 in haproxy -vv.
11376 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11377 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011378 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011379 h2" on the bind line.
11380
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011381ssl
11382 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011383 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011384 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11385 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011386 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11387 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011388
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011389ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11390 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11391 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11392 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11393
11394ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11395 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11396 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11397 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11398
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011399strict-sni
11400 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11401 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11402 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11403 See the "crt" option for more information.
11404
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011405tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011406 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011407 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11408 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011409 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011410 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11411 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11412 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11413 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11414 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11415 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11416 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11417
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011418tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011419 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011420 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11421 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11422 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11423 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11424 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11425 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11426 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011427 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11428 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11429 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011430
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011431tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11432 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011433 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11434 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11435 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11436 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11437 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11438 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11439 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11440 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11441 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11442 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011443 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11444 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11445
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011446transparent
11447 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11448 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11449 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11450 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11451 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11452 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11453 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11454 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11455 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11456 so check for support with your vendor.
11457
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011458v4v6
11459 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11460 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11461 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11462 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011463 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011464
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011465v6only
11466 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11467 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11468 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011469 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11470 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011471
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011472uid <uid>
11473 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11474 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11475 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11476 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11477 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11478
11479user <user>
11480 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11481 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11482 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11483 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11484 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11485
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011486verify [none|optional|required]
11487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11488 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11489 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11490 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11491 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011492 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11493 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11494 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11495 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011496
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114975.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011498------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011499
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011500The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11501which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11502arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11503settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11504after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11505Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11506address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011508 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011509 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011510
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011511Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11512keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011514The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011515
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011516addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011517 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011518 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11519 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11520 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11521 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11522 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011523
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011524agent-check
11525 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011526 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011527 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11528 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11529 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011530
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011531 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011532 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011533 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11534 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11535 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011536
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011537 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11538 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11539 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11540 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11541 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011542
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011543 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011544 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011545
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011546 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11547 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11548 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011549
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011550 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11551 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11552 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011553
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011554 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11555 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11556 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11557 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11558 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011559 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011560 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011561
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011562 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11563 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011564
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011565 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11566 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11567 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11568 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11569 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11570 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11571 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11572 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11573 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011574
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011575 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11576 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011577 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11578 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11579 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011580 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011581
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011582 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011583 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011584
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011585agent-send <string>
11586 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11587 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11588 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11589 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11590 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11591
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011592agent-inter <delay>
11593 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11594 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11595
11596 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11597 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11598 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11599 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11600 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11601 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11602 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11603 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11604 of backends use the same servers.
11605
11606 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11607
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011608agent-addr <addr>
11609 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11610
11611 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11612 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11613 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11614 hostname, it will be resolved.
11615
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011616agent-port <port>
11617 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11618
11619 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11620
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011621alpn <protocols>
11622 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11623 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11624 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11625 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11626 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11627 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11628 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11629 now obsolete NPN extension.
11630 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11631 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11632
11633 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011635backup
11636 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11637 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11638 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11639 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011640 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11641 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011642
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011643ca-file <cafile>
11644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11645 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11646 server's certificate.
11647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011648check
11649 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011650 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11651 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11652 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11653 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11654 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11655 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11656 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011657 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11658 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011659 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11660 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011661
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011662check-send-proxy
11663 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11664 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11665 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11666 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11667 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11668 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11669 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11670
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011671check-alpn <protocols>
11672 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11673 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11674 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11675
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011676check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011677 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011678 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11679 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011680
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011681check-ssl
11682 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11683 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11684 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11685 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011686 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011687 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11688 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011689 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011690 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11691 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011692
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011693ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011694 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11695 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11696 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011697 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11698 information and recommendations see e.g.
11699 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11700 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11701 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011702
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011703ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11704 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11705 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11706 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11707 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011708 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11709 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11710 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011712cookie <value>
11713 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11714 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11715 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11716 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11717 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11718 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11719 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11720
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011721crl-file <crlfile>
11722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11723 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11724 to verify server's certificate.
11725
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011726crt <cert>
11727 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11728 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11729 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11730 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11731 certificate request.
11732
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011733disabled
11734 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11735 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11736 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11737 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11738 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011739 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011740
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011741enabled
11742 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11743 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11744 default value.
11745 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11746 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011748error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011749 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11750 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11751 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011752
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011753 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011755fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011756 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11757 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11758 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11759
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011760force-sslv3
11761 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11762 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011763 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011764 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011765
11766force-tlsv10
11767 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011768 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011769 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011770
11771force-tlsv11
11772 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011773 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011774 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011775
11776force-tlsv12
11777 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011778 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011779 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011780
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011781force-tlsv13
11782 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11783 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011784 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011786id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011787 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11788 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11789 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011790
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011791init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11792 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11793 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011794 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011795 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11796 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11797 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11798 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11799 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11800 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11801 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11802 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11803 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011804 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011805 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11806 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11807 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11808 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11809 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11810 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011811 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011812
11813 Example:
11814 defaults
11815 # never fail on address resolution
11816 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011818inter <delay>
11819fastinter <delay>
11820downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011821 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11822 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11823 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11824 between checks depending on the server state :
11825
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011826 Server state | Interval used
11827 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11828 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11829 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11830 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11831 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11832 or yet unchecked. |
11833 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11834 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11835 | "inter" otherwise.
11836 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011837
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011838 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11839 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11840 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11841 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011842 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11843 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11844 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11845 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11846 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011848maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011849 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11850 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11851 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11852 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11853 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11854 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11855 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11856 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011858maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011859 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11860 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11861 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11862 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11863 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11864 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11865 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11866
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011867max-reuse <count>
11868 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11869 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11870 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11871 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11872 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11873 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11874 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11875 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011877minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011878 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11879 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11880 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11881 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11882 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11883 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011884 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011885 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011886
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011887namespace <name>
11888 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11889 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11890 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11891 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11892
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011893no-agent-check
11894 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11895 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11896 default value.
11897 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11898 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11899
11900no-backup
11901 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11902 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11903 default value.
11904 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11905 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11906
11907no-check
11908 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11909 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11910 default value.
11911 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11912 "default-server" "check" setting.
11913
11914no-check-ssl
11915 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11916 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11917 default value.
11918 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11919 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11920
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011921no-send-proxy
11922 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11923 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11924 default value.
11925 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11926 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11927
11928no-send-proxy-v2
11929 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11930 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11931 default value.
11932 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11933 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11934
11935no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11936 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11937 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11938 default value.
11939 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11940 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11941
11942no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11943 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11944 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11945 default value.
11946 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11947 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11948
11949no-ssl
11950 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11951 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11952 default value.
11953 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11954 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11955
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011956no-ssl-reuse
11957 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11958 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11959 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11960 and for paranoid users.
11961
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011962no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011963 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11964 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011965 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011966
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011967 Supported in default-server: No
11968
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011969no-tls-tickets
11970 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11971 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11972 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011973 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11974 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011975 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011976
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011977no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011978 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011979 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11980 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011981 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11982 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011983 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011984
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011985 Supported in default-server: No
11986
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011987no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011988 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011989 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11990 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011991 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11992 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011993 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011994
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011995 Supported in default-server: No
11996
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011997no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011998 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011999 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12000 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012001 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12002 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012003 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012004
12005 Supported in default-server: No
12006
12007no-tlsv13
12008 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12009 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12010 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12011 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12012 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012013 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012014
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012015 Supported in default-server: No
12016
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012017no-verifyhost
12018 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12019 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12020 default value.
12021 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12022 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012023
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012024non-stick
12025 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12026 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12027 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12028
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012029npn <protocols>
12030 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12031 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12032 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12033 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12034 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12035 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12036 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012038observe <mode>
12039 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12040 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12041 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12042 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12043 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12044 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012045 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012046
12047 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012049on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012050 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12051 Currently, four modes are available:
12052 - fastinter: force fastinter
12053 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12054 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12055 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12056 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12057
12058 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12059
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012060on-marked-down <action>
12061 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12062 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012063 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12064 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12065 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12066 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12067 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12068 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12069 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12070 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012071
12072 Actions are disabled by default
12073
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012074on-marked-up <action>
12075 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12076 Currently one action is available:
12077 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12078 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12079 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12080 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012081 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12082 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012083 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12084 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12085
12086 Actions are disabled by default
12087
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012088pool-max-conn <max>
12089 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12090 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12091 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12092 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12093 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12094 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12095
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012096pool-purge-delay <delay>
12097 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
12098 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means it's never purged. The default is
12099 1s.
12100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012101port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012102 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12103 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12104 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12105 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12106 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12107 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12108
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012109proto <name>
12110
12111 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12112 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12113 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12114 reported in haproxy -vv.
12115 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12116 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012118redir <prefix>
12119 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12120 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12121 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12122 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12123 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12124 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12125 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12126 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012127 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012128 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012129 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12130 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12131 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12132 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12133
12134 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012136rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012137 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12138 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12139 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12140
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012141resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12142 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12143 server.
12144
12145 Available options:
12146
12147 * allow-dup-ip
12148 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12149 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12150 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12151 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12152 For such case, simply enable this option.
12153 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12154
12155 * prevent-dup-ip
12156 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12157 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12158 same fqdn.
12159 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12160
12161 Example:
12162 backend b_myapp
12163 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12164 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12165 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12166
12167 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12168 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12169 it
12170 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12171 different address
12172
12173 Default value: not set
12174
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012175resolve-prefer <family>
12176 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12177 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12178 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12179 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12180
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012181 Default value: ipv6
12182
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012183 Example:
12184
12185 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012186
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012187resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12188 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12189 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012190 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012191 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12192 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012193 configured network, another address is selected.
12194
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012195 Example:
12196
12197 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012198
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012199resolvers <id>
12200 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12201 hostname.
12202
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012203 Example:
12204
12205 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012206
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012207 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012208
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012209send-proxy
12210 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12211 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12212 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12213 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012214 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12215 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12216 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12217 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12218 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12219 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12220 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12221 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12222 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12223 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012224 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12225 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012226
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012227send-proxy-v2
12228 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12229 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12230 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12231 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012232 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12233 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12234 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12235 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012236
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012237proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12238 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12239 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012240 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12241 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012242 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12243 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012244 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012245
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012246send-proxy-v2-ssl
12247 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12248 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12249 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12250 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12251 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12252 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12253 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012254 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12255 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012256
12257send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12258 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12259 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12260 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12261 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12262 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12263 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12264 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12265 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012266 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12267 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012269slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012270 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12271 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12272 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12273 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12274 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12275 parameters :
12276
12277 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12278 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12279
12280 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12281 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12282 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12283 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12284
12285 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12286 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12287 seen as failed.
12288
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012289sni <expression>
12290 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12291 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12292 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12293 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012294 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12295 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012296 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012297 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12298 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012299
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012300source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012301source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012302source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012303 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12304 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12305 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12306 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12307
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012308 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12309 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12310 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12311 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12312 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12313 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12314 server.
12315
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012316 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12317 specifying the source address without port(s).
12318
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012319ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012320 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12321 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12322 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12323 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12324 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12325 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012326 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12327 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012328
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012329ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12330 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12331 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12332 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12333
12334ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12335 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12336 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12337 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12338
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012339ssl-reuse
12340 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12341 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12342 default value.
12343 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12344 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12345
12346stick
12347 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12348 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12349 default value.
12350 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12351 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012352
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012353tcp-ut <delay>
12354 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12355 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12356 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012357 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012358 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12359 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12360 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12361 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12362 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12363 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12364 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12365 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12366 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012368track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012369 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12370 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12371 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12372 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012373 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12374
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012375tls-tickets
12376 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12377 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12378 default value.
12379 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12380 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012381
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012382verify [none|required]
12383 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012384 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012385 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12386 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012387 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012388 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12389 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12390 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12391 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12392 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12393 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12394 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12395 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012396
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012397verifyhost <hostname>
12398 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012399 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12400 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12401 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12402 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12403 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12404 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12405 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12406 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012408weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012409 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12410 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12411 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012412 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12413 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12414 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12415 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12416 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12417 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012418
12419
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124205.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12421-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012422
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012423HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12424using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12425configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012426This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12427can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12428workload.
12429This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12430resolution at run time.
12431Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12432carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12433
12434
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124355.3.1. Global overview
12436----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012437
12438As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12439different steps of the process life:
12440
12441 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12442 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12443 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12444
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012445 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12446 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012447
12448A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12449 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12450 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12451 resolution to know this new IP.
12452
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012453When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012454HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012455SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12456from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12457will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12458will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012459
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012460A few things important to notice:
12461 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12462 first valid response.
12463
12464 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12465 servers return an error.
12466
12467
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124685.3.2. The resolvers section
12469----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012470
12471This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012472HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12473contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012474
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012475When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12476uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12477is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12478answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12479
12480When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012481used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012482
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012483 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12484 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12485 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012486
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012487 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12488 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012489
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012490 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12491 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12492 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012493
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012494For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12495following scenarios are possible:
12496
12497 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12498 ignored
12499
12500 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12501 applied
12502
12503 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12504 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12505
12506 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12507 retries the query with a new type
12508
12509 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12510 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012511
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012512As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12513a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012514<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012515
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012516
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012517resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012518 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012519
12520A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12521
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012522accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012523 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012524 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012525 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12526 by RFC 6891)
12527
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012528 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12529
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012530nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12531 DNS server description:
12532 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12533 <ip> : IP address of the server
12534 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12535
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012536parse-resolv-conf
12537 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12538 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12539 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12540
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012541hold <status> <period>
12542 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12543 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012544 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012545 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012546 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12547 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12548 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12549
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012550 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012551
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012552resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012553 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12554 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12555 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12556
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012557resolve_retries <nb>
12558 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12559 giving up.
12560 Default value: 3
12561
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012562 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12563 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12564 type.
12565
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012566timeout <event> <time>
12567 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12568 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12569 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012570 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12571 other time applied.
12572 Default value: 1s
12573 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12574 have been received.
12575 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012576 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12577 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12578
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012579 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012580
12581 resolvers mydns
12582 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12583 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012584 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012585 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012586 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012587 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012588 hold other 30s
12589 hold refused 30s
12590 hold nx 30s
12591 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012592 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012593 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012594
12595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125966. HTTP header manipulation
12597---------------------------
12598
12599In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12600response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12601request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12602which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012603against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012605If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12606to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12607but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12608HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12609stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12610because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12611a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12612still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012613
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012614This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12615in section 4.2 :
12616
12617 - reqadd <string>
12618 - reqallow <search>
12619 - reqiallow <search>
12620 - reqdel <search>
12621 - reqidel <search>
12622 - reqdeny <search>
12623 - reqideny <search>
12624 - reqpass <search>
12625 - reqipass <search>
12626 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12627 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12628 - reqtarpit <search>
12629 - reqitarpit <search>
12630 - rspadd <string>
12631 - rspdel <search>
12632 - rspidel <search>
12633 - rspdeny <search>
12634 - rspideny <search>
12635 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12636 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12637
12638With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12639is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12640parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12641prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12642Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12643
12644 \t for a tab
12645 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12646 \n for a new line (LF)
12647 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12648 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12649 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12650 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12651 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12652
12653The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12654portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12655above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12656regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
126579 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12658is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12659
12660The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12661after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12662
12663Notes related to these keywords :
12664---------------------------------
12665 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12666 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12667 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12668
12669 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12670 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12671 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12672
12673 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12674 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12675 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12676 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12677 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12678
12679 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12680 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12681 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12682 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12683 useless headers before adding new ones.
12684
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012685 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012686 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12687
12688 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12689 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12690 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12691
12692 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12693 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012694 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012695
12696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126977. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12698----------------------------------
12699
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012700HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012701client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12702The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12703these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12704but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12705data called patterns.
12706
12707
127087.1. ACL basics
12709---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012710
12711The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12712content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12713from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12714simple :
12715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012716 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012717 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012718 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12719 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012721The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12722adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012723
12724In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012726 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012727
12728This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12729Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12730and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012731an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12732conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12733as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12734are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012735
12736ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12737'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12738which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12739
12740There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12741performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012743The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12744specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12745this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012746methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12747ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012748
12749Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12750 - boolean
12751 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12752 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12753 - string
12754 - data block
12755
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012756Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12757converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12758would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12759The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12760which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12761
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012762Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12763keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12764fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12765which are summarized in the table below :
12766
12767 +---------------------+-----------------+
12768 | Sample or converter | Default |
12769 | output type | matching method |
12770 +---------------------+-----------------+
12771 | boolean | bool |
12772 +---------------------+-----------------+
12773 | integer | int |
12774 +---------------------+-----------------+
12775 | ip | ip |
12776 +---------------------+-----------------+
12777 | string | str |
12778 +---------------------+-----------------+
12779 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12780 +---------------------+-----------------+
12781
12782Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12783matching method, see below.
12784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012785The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12786 - boolean
12787 - integer or integer range
12788 - IP address / network
12789 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12790 - regular expression
12791 - hex block
12792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012793The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12794
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012795 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12796 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012798 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012799 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012800 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012801 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012803The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12804read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12805if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12806lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12807will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12808beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12809a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12810lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12811exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12812
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012813The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12814parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12815ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12816a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12817check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12818
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012819The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12820socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12821file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012823Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12824loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12825
12826 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12827
12828In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12829the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12830case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12831as well.
12832
12833The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12834sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12835do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12836methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12837is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012838obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012839followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12840default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12841that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12842string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12843
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012844The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12845By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12846string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12847resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12848server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12849waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12850flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12851function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012853There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12854sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12855be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012856
12857 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12858 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012859 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12860 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12861 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12862 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012863
12864 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12865 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012866 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012867
12868 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012869 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012870
12871 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012872 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012873
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012874 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012875 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12876
12877 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12878 binary or string samples.
12879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012880 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12881 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012883 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12884 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12885 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012887 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12888 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012890 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12891 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12894 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012896 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12897 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012898 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012900 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12901 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12902 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012903
12904For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12905request, it is possible to do :
12906
12907 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12908
12909In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12910buffer, one would use the following acl :
12911
12912 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12913
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012914On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12915possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12916
12917 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012919All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12920criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12921method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12922to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12923criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12924the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012926If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012927the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12928For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12931 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12932 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12933 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012934
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012935
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012936The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12937types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12938combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12939brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12940default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012942 +-------------------------------------------------+
12943 | Input sample type |
12944 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012945 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012946 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12947 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12948 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012949 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012950 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012951 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012952 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012953 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012954 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012955 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012956 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012957 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012958 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012959 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012960 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012961 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012962 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012963 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012964 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012965 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012966 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012967 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012968 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012969 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012970 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12971 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12972 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012973
12974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129757.1.1. Matching booleans
12976------------------------
12977
12978In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12979Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12980When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12981that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12982
12983Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12984return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12985"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12986
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129887.1.2. Matching integers
12989------------------------
12990
12991Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12992enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12993to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12994
12995Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12996matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12997lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012998
12999For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13000unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13001representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13002
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013003As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13004two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13005instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13006ranges and operators.
13007
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013008For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013009operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13010Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13011of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013012
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013013Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013014
13015 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13016 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13017 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13018 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13019 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13020
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013021For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013022
13023 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13024
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013025This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13026
13027 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13028
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130307.1.3. Matching strings
13031-----------------------
13032
13033String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13034different forms :
13035
13036 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013037 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013038
13039 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013040 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013041
13042 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13043 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13044
13045 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13046 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13047
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013048 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013049 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13050 matches.
13051
13052 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13053 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13054 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013055
13056String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13057exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13058characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13059string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13060to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013061before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013062
13063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130647.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13065---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013066
13067Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13068they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13069possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13070passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13071the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013072the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13073match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013074
13075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130767.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13077-------------------------------------
13078
13079It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13080not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13081a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13082to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13083digits may be used upper or lower case.
13084
13085Example :
13086 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13087 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13088
13089
130907.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13091---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013092
13093IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13094netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13095within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013096host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013097difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13098at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13099does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13100parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013101
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013102The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13103abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13104
13105 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13106 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13107 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13108 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13109 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13110 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13111 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13112 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13113
13114Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13115192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13116
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013117IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13118Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13119trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13120IPv6 patterns.
13121
13122HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13123following situations :
13124 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13125 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13126 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13127 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13128 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13129 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13130 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13131 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13132 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13133 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013135
131367.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13137----------------------------------
13138
13139Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13140combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13141
13142 - AND (implicit)
13143 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13144 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013146A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013148 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013150Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13151indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013153For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13154"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13155requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13156is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13157
13158 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013159 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13160 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13161 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013162
13163To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13164and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13165
13166 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13167 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13168 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13169 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13170
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013171 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013172 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13173 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13174 use_backend www if host_www
13175
13176It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13177expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13178be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13179the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13180
13181 The following rule :
13182
13183 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013184 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013185
13186 Can also be written that way :
13187
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013188 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013189
13190It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13191to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13192simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13193sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13194good use is the following :
13195
13196 With named ACLs :
13197
13198 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13199 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13200 monitor fail if site_dead
13201
13202 With anonymous ACLs :
13203
13204 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13205
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013206See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13207keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208
13209
132107.3. Fetching samples
13211---------------------
13212
13213Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13214against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13215sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13216ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13217of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13218available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13219
13220This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13221Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13222compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13223deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13224
13225The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13226matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13227method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13228indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13229
13230As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13231when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13232mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13233the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13234ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13235
13236Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13237multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13238when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013239incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13240are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013241is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13242all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13243
13244Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13245 - name
13246 - name(arg1)
13247 - name(arg1,arg2)
13248
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013249
132507.3.1. Converters
13251-----------------
13252
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013253Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13254of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13255is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13256was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013257has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013258unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13259
13260These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13261sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13262the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013263support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013264
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013265A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13266support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13267supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13268(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13269bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013271The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013272
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001327351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13274 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13275 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13276 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13277 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13278 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13279
13280 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013281 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13282 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013283 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13284 frontend http-in
13285 bind *:8081
13286 default_backend servers
13287 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13288 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13289
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013290add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013291 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013292 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013293 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13294 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013295 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013296 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13297 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13298 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13299 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013301 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013302
13303and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013304 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013305 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013306 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13307 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013308 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013309 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13310 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13311 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13312 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013313 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013314 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013315
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013316b64dec
13317 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13318 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13319
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013320base64
13321 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013322 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013323 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13324
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013325bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013326 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013327 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013328 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013329 presence of a flag).
13330
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013331bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13332 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13333 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013334 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013335
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013336concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13337 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13338 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13339 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13340 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13341 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13342 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13343 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13344 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13345 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13346 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13347 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13348 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13349 delimitors.
13350
13351 Example:
13352 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13353 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13354 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13355 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13356
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013357cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013358 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13359 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013360
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013361crc32([<avalanche>])
13362 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13363 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13364 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13365 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13366 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13367 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13368 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13369 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13370 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13371 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013372 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13373
13374crc32c([<avalanche>])
13375 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13376 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13377 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13378 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13379 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13380 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13381 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13382 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013383
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013384da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013385 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13386 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13387 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13388 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013389 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013390 configuration language.
13391
13392 Example:
13393 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013394 bind *:8881
13395 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013396 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013397
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013398debug
13399 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13400 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13401 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13402
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013403div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013404 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13405 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013406 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013407 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13408 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013409 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013410 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13411 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13412 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13413 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013414 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013415 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013416
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013417djb2([<avalanche>])
13418 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13419 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13420 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13421 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13422 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13423 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13424 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013425 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13426 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013427
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013428even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013429 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013430 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13431
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013432field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13433 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13434 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13435 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13436 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13437 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13438 fields.
13439
13440 Example :
13441 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13442 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13443 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13444 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13445 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013446
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013447hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013448 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013449 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013450 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013451 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013452
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013453hex2i
13454 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13455 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13456
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013457http_date([<offset>])
13458 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13459 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13460 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13461 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13462 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13463 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013464
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013465in_table(<table>)
13466 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13467 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13468 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013469 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013470 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13471
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013472ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13473 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013474 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013475 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13476 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13477 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13478 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13479 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013480
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013481json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013482 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013483 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013484 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013485 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13486 of errors:
13487 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13488 bytes, ...)
13489 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13490 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13491
13492 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13493 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13494 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13495 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13496 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13497 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013498 - "ascii" : never fails;
13499 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13500 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013501 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013502 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013503 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13504 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13505
13506 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013507 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013508
13509 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013510 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013511 capture request header user-agent len 150
13512 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013513
13514 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13515 GET / HTTP/1.0
13516 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13517
13518 Output log:
13519 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13520
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013521language(<value>[,<default>])
13522 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13523 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13524 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13525 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13526 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13527 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13528 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13529 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13530 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013531 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013532 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13533 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013534
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013535 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013536
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013537 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13538 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013539
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013540 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13541 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13542 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13543 use_backend spanish if es
13544 use_backend french if fr
13545 use_backend english if en
13546 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013547
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013548length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013549 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13550 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13551 type. The result is of type integer.
13552
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013553lower
13554 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13555 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13556 type. The result is of type string.
13557
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013558ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13559 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13560 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13561 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13562 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13563 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13564 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13565
13566 Example :
13567
13568 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013569 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013570 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13571
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013572map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13573map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13574map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13575 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13576 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13577 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13578 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13579 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13580 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13581 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13582 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013583
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013584 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13585 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13586 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013587
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013588 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013589 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013590
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013591 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13592 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13593 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13594 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013595 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13596 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013597 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13598 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13599 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13600 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13601 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13602 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13603 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13604 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013605 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13606 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13607 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013608 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13609 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13610 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13611 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13612 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013613
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013614 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13615 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13616 the corresponding match text.
13617
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013618 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13619 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13620 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13621 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13622 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013623
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013624 Example :
13625
13626 # this is a comment and is ignored
13627 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13628 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13629 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13630 | | | `---------- value
13631 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13632 | `---------------------------- key
13633 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13634
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013635mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013636 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13637 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013638 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013639 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013640 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013641 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13642 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13643 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13644 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013645 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013646 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013647
13648mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013649 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013650 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13651 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013652 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013653 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013654 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013655 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13656 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13657 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13658 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013659 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013660 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013661
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013662nbsrv
13663 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13664 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13665 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13666 map lookup.
13667
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013668neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013669 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13670 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13671 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13672 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013673
13674not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013675 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013676 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013677 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013678 absence of a flag).
13679
13680odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013681 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013682 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13683
13684or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013685 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013686 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013687 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13688 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013689 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013690 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13691 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13692 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13693 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013694 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013695 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013696
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013697regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013698 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13699 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13700 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13701 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13702 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13703 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13704 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13705 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13706 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13707 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013708 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13709 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13710 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13711 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013712
13713 Example :
13714
13715 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13716 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13717 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13718 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13719
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013720capture-req(<id>)
13721 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13722 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13723
13724 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013725 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13726 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013727
13728capture-res(<id>)
13729 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13730 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13731
13732 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013733 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13734 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013735
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013736sdbm([<avalanche>])
13737 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13738 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13739 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13740 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13741 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13742 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13743 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013744 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13745 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013746
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013747set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013748 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13749 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13750 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013751 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013752 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13753 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013754 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013755 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13756 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013757 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013758 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013759
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013760sha1
13761 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13762 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13763
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013764strcmp(<var>)
13765 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13766 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13767 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13768 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13769 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13770 shorter).
13771
13772 Example :
13773
13774 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13775 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13776 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13777
13778
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013779sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013780 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13781 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013782 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013783 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13784 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013785 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013786 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13787 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013788 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013789 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13790 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013791 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013792 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013793
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010013794svarint
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013795 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers signed "varint" ("sint32"
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010013796 and "sint64") to an integer.
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013797 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010013798 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13799
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013800table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13801 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13802 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13803 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13804 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13805 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13806 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13807
13808
13809table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13810 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13811 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13812 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13813 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13814 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13815 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13816
13817table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13818 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13819 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013820 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013821 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13822 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13823
13824table_conn_cur(<table>)
13825 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13826 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13827 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13828 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13829 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13830
13831table_conn_rate(<table>)
13832 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13833 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13834 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13835 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13836 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13837
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013838table_gpt0(<table>)
13839 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13840 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13841 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13842 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13843 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13844
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013845table_gpc0(<table>)
13846 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13847 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13848 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13849 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13850 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13851
13852table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13853 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13854 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13855 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13856 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13857 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13858 sample fetch keyword.
13859
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013860table_gpc1(<table>)
13861 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13862 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13863 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13864 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13865 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13866
13867table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13868 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13869 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13870 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13871 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13872 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13873 sample fetch keyword.
13874
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013875table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13876 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13877 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013878 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013879 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13880 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13881
13882table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13885 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13886 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13887 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13888 keyword.
13889
13890table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13891 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13892 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013893 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013894 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13895 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13896
13897table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13898 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13899 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13900 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13901 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13902 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13903 keyword.
13904
13905table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13906 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13907 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013908 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013909 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13910 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13911 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13912 keyword.
13913
13914table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13915 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13916 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013917 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013918 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13919 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13920 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13921 keyword.
13922
13923table_server_id(<table>)
13924 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13925 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13926 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13927 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13928 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13929 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13930
13931table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13932 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13933 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013934 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013935 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13936 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13937 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13938 keyword.
13939
13940table_sess_rate(<table>)
13941 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13942 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13943 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13944 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13945 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13946 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13947 keyword.
13948
13949table_trackers(<table>)
13950 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13951 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13952 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13953 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13954 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13955 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13956 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13957 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13958 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13959 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13960
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013961upper
13962 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13963 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13964 type. The result is of type string.
13965
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013966url_dec
13967 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13968 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13969
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013970ungrpc(<field_number>) : binary
13971 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13972 sample with <field_number> as field number (dotted notation).
13973
13974 Example:
13975 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13976 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13977
13978 message Point {
13979 int32 latitude = 1;
13980 int32 longitude = 2;
13981 }
13982
13983 message PPoint {
13984 Point point = 59;
13985 }
13986
13987 message Rectangle {
13988 // One corner of the rectangle.
13989 PPoint lo = 48;
13990 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13991 PPoint hi = 49;
13992 }
13993
13994 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13995 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13996 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13997
13998 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13999 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14000 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14001 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14002
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014003unset-var(<var name>)
14004 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14005 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14006 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14007 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14008 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14009 response),
14010 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14011 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14012 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14013 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14014
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014015utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14016 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14017 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14018 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14019 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14020 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14021 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14022
14023 Example :
14024
14025 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014026 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014027 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14028
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014029varint
14030 Converts a binary input sample of a protocol buffers "varint", excepted
14031 the signed ones "sint32" and "sint64", to an integer.
14032 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14033 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14034
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014035word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14036 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14037 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14038 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14039 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14040 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14041
14042 Example :
14043 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14044 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14045 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14046 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14047 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014048
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014049wt6([<avalanche>])
14050 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14051 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14052 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14053 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14054 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14055 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14056 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014057 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14058 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014059
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014060xor(<value>)
14061 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014062 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014063 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014064 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014065 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014066 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14067 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014068 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014069 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14070 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014071 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014072 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014073
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014074xxh32([<seed>])
14075 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14076 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14077 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14078 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14079 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14080 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14081 as cryptographically secure.
14082
14083xxh64([<seed>])
14084 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14085 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14086 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14087 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14088 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14089 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14090 as cryptographically secure.
14091
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014092
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140937.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014094--------------------------------------------
14095
14096A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14097not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14098"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14099The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14100
14101always_false : boolean
14102 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14103 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14104
14105always_true : boolean
14106 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14107 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14108
14109avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014110 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014111 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14112 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14113 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14114 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14115 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14116 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14117 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14118 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14119 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14120 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14121 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14122 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14123 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014126 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14127 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14128 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14129 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014130 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14131
14132be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14133 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14134 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14135 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14136 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14137 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014138 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14139 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014140
14141 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14142 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14143 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014145be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14146 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14147 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14148 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014149 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014150 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14151 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014152
14153 Example :
14154 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14155 backend dynamic
14156 mode http
14157 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14158 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014159
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014160bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014161 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14162 of the string.
14163
14164bool(<bool>) : bool
14165 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14166 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014168connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14169 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014170 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014171 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14172 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014173
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014174 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014175 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014176 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14177
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014178 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14179 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014180
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014181 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014182 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014183 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014184 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014185 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014186 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014187 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014188
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014189 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14190 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014191 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014192 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014193
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014194cpu_calls : integer
14195 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14196 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14197 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14198 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14199 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14200 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14201
14202cpu_ns_avg : integer
14203 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14204 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14205 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14206 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14207 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14208 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14209 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14210 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14211 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14212 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14213 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14214
14215cpu_ns_tot : integer
14216 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14217 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14218 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14219 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14220 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14221 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14222 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14223 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14224 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14225 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14226 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14227 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14228 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14229
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014230date([<offset>]) : integer
14231 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14232 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14233 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14234 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014235 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14236
14237 Example :
14238
14239 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14240 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014241
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014242date_us : integer
14243 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14244 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14245 from the same timeval structure.
14246
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014247distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14248 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14249 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14250 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14251 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14252 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14253 list of supported tokens.
14254
14255distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14256 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14257 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14258 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14259 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14260 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14261 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14262 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14263 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14264 supported tokens.
14265
14266 Example :
14267 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14268 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14269 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14270 # send large files to the big farm
14271 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14272
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014273env(<name>) : string
14274 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14275 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14276 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14277 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14278 certain way.
14279
14280 Examples :
14281 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14282 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14283
14284 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14285 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14288 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014289 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14290 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014291 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14292 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014293 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014294 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14295 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014296
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014297fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14298 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14299 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14300 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14303 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14304 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14305 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14306 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14307 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14308 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14309 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14310 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014311
14312 Example :
14313 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14314 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14315 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14316 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14317 frontend mail
14318 bind :25
14319 mode tcp
14320 maxconn 100
14321 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14322 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14323 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14324 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014325
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014326hostname : string
14327 Returns the system hostname.
14328
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014329int(<integer>) : signed integer
14330 Returns a signed integer.
14331
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014332ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14333 Returns an ipv4.
14334
14335ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14336 Returns an ipv6.
14337
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014338lat_ns_avg : integer
14339 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14340 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14341 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14342 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14343 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14344 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14345 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14346 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14347 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14348 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14349 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14350 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14351 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14352 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14353
14354lat_ns_tot : integer
14355 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14356 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14357 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14358 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14359 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14360 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14361 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14362 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14363 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14364 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14365 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14366 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14367 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14368 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14369 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14370 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14371 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14372 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14373 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14374
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014375meth(<method>) : method
14376 Returns a method.
14377
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014378nbproc : integer
14379 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14380 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14381 and debugging purposes.
14382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014383nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14384 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14385 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14386 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014387 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14388 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14389 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014390
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014391prio_class : integer
14392 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14393 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14394 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14395
14396prio_offset : integer
14397 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14398 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14399 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14400 set-priority-offset".
14401
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014402proc : integer
14403 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14404 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14405 debugging purposes.
14406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014407queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014408 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14409 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14410 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014411 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14412 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14413 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14414 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14415 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14416
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014417rand([<range>]) : integer
14418 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14419 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14420 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14421 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14422 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014424srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14425 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14426 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14427 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14428 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14429 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014430 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14431 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14432
14433srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14434 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14435 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14436 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14437 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14438 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14439 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14440 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14441
14442 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14443 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014444
14445srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14446 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14447 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14448 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014449 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14451 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14452 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14453
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014454srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14455 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14456 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14457 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14458 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14459 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14460 fetch methods.
14461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014462srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14463 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14464 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014465 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14467 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014468 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014469 overloading servers).
14470
14471 Example :
14472 # Redirect to a separate back
14473 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14474 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14475 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14476
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014477stopping : boolean
14478 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14479 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14480 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14481
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014482str(<string>) : string
14483 Returns a string.
14484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014485table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14486 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14487 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14488
14489table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14490 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14491 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14492 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14493
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014494thread : integer
14495 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14496 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14497 and debugging purposes.
14498
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014499var(<var-name>) : undefined
14500 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014501 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14502 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014503 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014504 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14505 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014506 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014507 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14508 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014509 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014510 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014511
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200145127.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014513----------------------------------
14514
14515The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14516closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14517methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14518sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14519TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014520the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14521counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014522"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14523used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14524can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14525Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14526table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14527tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14528currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014529
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014530bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014531 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14532 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14533 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535be_id : integer
14536 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14537 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14538
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014539be_name : string
14540 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14541 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014543dst : ip
14544 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14545 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14546 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14547 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014548 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14549 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14550 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14551 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14552 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14553 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014554
14555dst_conn : integer
14556 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14557 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14558 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14559 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14560 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14561 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14562 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14563 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014564
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014565dst_is_local : boolean
14566 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14567 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14568 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14569 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014570 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014571 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14572 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14573 it only once per connection.
14574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014575dst_port : integer
14576 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14577 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14578 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14579 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14580 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14581 an HTTP header.
14582
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014583fc_http_major : integer
14584 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14585 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14586 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14587
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014588fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14589 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14590 header.
14591
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014592fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14593 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14594 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14595 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14596 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14597 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14598 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14599
14600fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14601 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14602 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14603 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14604 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14605 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14606 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14607
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014608fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14609 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14610 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14611 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14612 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14613
14614fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14615 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14616 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14617 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14618 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14619
14620fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14621 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14622 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14623 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14624 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14625
14626fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14627 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14628 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14629 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14630 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14631
14632fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14633 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14634 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14635 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14636 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14637
14638fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14639 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14640 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14641 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14642 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14643
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014644fe_defbe : string
14645 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14646 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648fe_id : integer
14649 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014650 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014651 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14652
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014653fe_name : string
14654 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14655 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14656 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14657
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014658sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014659sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14660sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14661sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014662 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14663 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14664 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14665
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014666sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014667sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14668sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14669sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014670 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14671 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14672 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14673
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014674sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014675sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14676sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14677sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014678 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14679 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014680 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14681 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14682 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014683
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014684 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014685 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14686 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014687 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14688 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14689 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014690 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14691 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14692
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014693sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14694sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14695sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14696sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14697 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14698 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14699 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14700 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14701 when a first ACL was verified.
14702
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014703sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014704sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14705sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14706sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014707 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014708 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14709
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014710sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014711sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14712sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14713sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014714 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14715 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14716 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014718sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014719sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14720sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14721sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014722 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14723 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14724 See also src_conn_rate.
14725
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014726sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014727sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14728sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14729sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014730 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014731 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014732
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014733sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14734sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14735sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14736sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14737 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14738 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14739
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014740sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14741sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14742sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14743sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14744 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14745 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14746
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014747sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014748sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14749sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14750sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014751 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14752 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14753 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014754 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14755 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14756 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014757
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014758sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14759sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14760sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14761sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14762 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14763 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14764 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14765 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14766 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14767 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14768
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014769sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014770sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14771sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14772sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014773 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014774 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14775 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014777sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014778sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14779sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14780sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014781 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14782 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14783 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14784 src_http_err_rate.
14785
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014786sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014787sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14788sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14789sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014790 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014791 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14792 src_http_req_cnt.
14793
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014794sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014795sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14796sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14797sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014798 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14799 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14800 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14801 src_http_req_rate.
14802
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014803sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014804sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14805sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14806sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014807 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014808 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14809 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14810 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14811 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014812
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014813 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014814 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14815 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014816 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14817
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014818sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14819sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14820sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14821sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14822 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14823 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14824 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14825 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14826 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14827
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014828sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014829sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14830sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14831sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014832 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14833 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14834 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014835
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014836sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014837sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14838sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14839sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014840 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14841 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14842 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014843
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014844sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014845sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14846sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14847sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014848 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014849 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14850 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14851 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014852 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014853 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14854
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014855sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014856sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14857sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14858sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014859 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14860 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14861 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14862 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14863 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014864 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014865
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014866sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014867sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14868sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14869sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014870 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14871 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14872 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14873
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014874sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014875sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14876sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14877sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014878 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14879 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014880 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014881 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14882 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14884 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14885 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014887so_id : integer
14888 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14889 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14890 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014893 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14895 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14896 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014897 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14898 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14899 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014900 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14901 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14902 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14903 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14904 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14905 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14906 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014907
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014908 Example:
14909 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14910 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014912src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14913 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14914 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14915 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014916 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14919 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14920 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014921 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014922 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14925 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14926 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14927 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14928 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14929 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14930 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014931
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014932 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014933 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14934 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14935 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14936 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014937 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014938 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14939 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14940
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014941src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14942 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14943 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14944 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14945 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14946 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14947 was verified.
14948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014949src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014950 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014951 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014952 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014953 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014956 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14958 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014959 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014961src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14962 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14963 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14964 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014965 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014968 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014970 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014971 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014972
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014973src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14974 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14975 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14976 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14977 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14978
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014979src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14980 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14981 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14982 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14983 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014986 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014988 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14989 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014990 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14991 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14992 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014993
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014994src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14995 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14996 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14997 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14998 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14999 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15000 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15001 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015004 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015006 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015007 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015008 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015010src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15011 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15012 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15013 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15014 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015015 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015017src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015018 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015019 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15020 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015021 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15024 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15025 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15026 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015027 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015028 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015030src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15031 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15032 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15033 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015034 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15036 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015037
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015038 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015039 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015040 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015041 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015042
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015043src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15044 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15045 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15046 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15047 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15048 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15049 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15050
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015051src_is_local : boolean
15052 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15053 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15054 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15055 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015056 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015057 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15058 once per connection.
15059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015061 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15062 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15063 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15064 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15065 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015067src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015068 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15069 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15070 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15071 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15072 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074src_port : integer
15075 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15076 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15077 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15078 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015081 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015082 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15083 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15084 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015085 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015087src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15088 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15089 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15090 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15091 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015092 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15095 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15096 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15097 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15098 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15099 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15100 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15101 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15102 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015103
15104 Example :
15105 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15106 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15107 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15108 listen ssh
15109 bind :22
15110 mode tcp
15111 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015112 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015114 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116srv_id : integer
15117 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15118 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15119 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015120
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151217.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015122----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015124The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15125closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15126when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15127usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015128future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015129
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001513051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15131 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15132 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15133 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15134 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15135 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15136
15137 Example :
15138 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15139 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15140 # the request.
15141 frontend http-in
15142 bind *:8081
15143 default_backend servers
15144 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15145 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15146
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015147ssl_bc : boolean
15148 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15149 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15150 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15151
15152ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15153 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15154 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15155
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015156ssl_bc_alpn : string
15157 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15158 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15159 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15160 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15161 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15162 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15163 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15164 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15165 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15166
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015167ssl_bc_cipher : string
15168 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15169 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15170
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015171ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15172 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15173 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15174 session or a TLS ticket.
15175
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015176ssl_bc_npn : string
15177 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15178 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15179 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15180 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15181 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15182 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15183 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15184 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15185
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015186ssl_bc_protocol : string
15187 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15188 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15189
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015190ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015191 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015192 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15193 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015194
15195ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15196 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15197 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15198 if session was reused or not.
15199
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015200ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15201 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15202 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15203 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15204 BoringSSL.
15205
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015206ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15207 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15208 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015210ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15211 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15212 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15213 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15214 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15215 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15218 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15219 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15220 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15221 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015222
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015223ssl_c_der : binary
15224 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15225 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15226 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015228ssl_c_err : integer
15229 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15230 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15231 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15232 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15233 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015235ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15236 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15237 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15238 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15239 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15240 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15241 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15242 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15243 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245ssl_c_key_alg : string
15246 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15247 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15248 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250ssl_c_notafter : string
15251 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15252 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15253 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255ssl_c_notbefore : string
15256 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15257 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15258 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15261 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15262 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15263 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15264 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15265 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15266 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15267 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15268 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270ssl_c_serial : binary
15271 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15272 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15273 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15276 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15277 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15278 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015279 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15280 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15281
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015282 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015283 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15286 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15287 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15288 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015290ssl_c_used : boolean
15291 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15292 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015294ssl_c_verify : integer
15295 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15296 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15297 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15298 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300ssl_c_version : integer
15301 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15302 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015303
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015304ssl_f_der : binary
15305 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15306 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15307 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015309ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15310 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15311 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15312 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15313 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015314 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015315 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15316 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15317 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319ssl_f_key_alg : string
15320 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15321 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15322 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324ssl_f_notafter : string
15325 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15326 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15327 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015329ssl_f_notbefore : string
15330 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15331 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15332 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015334ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15335 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15336 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15337 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15338 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15339 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15340 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15341 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15342 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015344ssl_f_serial : binary
15345 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15346 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15347 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015348
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015349ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15350 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15351 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15352 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015354ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15355 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15356 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15357 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015359ssl_f_version : integer
15360 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15361 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15362
15363ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015364 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15365 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15366 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368 Example :
15369 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15370 listen http-https
15371 bind :80
15372 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15373 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15374
15375ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15376 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15377 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15378
15379ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015380 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015381 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15382 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15383 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15384 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15385 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15386 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15387 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15388 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015390ssl_fc_cipher : string
15391 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15392 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015393
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015394ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15395 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15396 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015397 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015398
15399ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15400 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15401 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015402 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015403
15404ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15405 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15406 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15407 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015408 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015409 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015410
15411ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15412 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15413 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015414 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015416ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015417 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15418 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015419 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15420 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15421 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15422 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015423
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015424ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15425 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15426 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15427 wait until the handshake happened.
15428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15430 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015431 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15432 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15433 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15434 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015435
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015436ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015437 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015438 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15439 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015441ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015442 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15444 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15445 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15446 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15447 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15448 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15449 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015451ssl_fc_protocol : string
15452 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15453 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015454
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015455ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015456 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015457 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15458 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15461 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15462 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15463 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15464 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015465
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015466ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15467 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15468 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15469 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15470 BoringSSL.
15471
15472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473ssl_fc_sni : string
15474 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15475 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15476 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15477 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15478 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15479
15480 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15481 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15482 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015483 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15484 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15488 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15491 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15492 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015493
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154957.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015498Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15499sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15500only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15501For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15502be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15503can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15504sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15505for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15506content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015509 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015510 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15511 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015513payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15514 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015515 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015517
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015518req.hdrs : string
15519 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15520 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15521 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15522 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15523
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015524req.hdrs_bin : binary
15525 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15526 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15527 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15528 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15529 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15530 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15531
15532 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15533
15534 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15535 str: <int:length><bytes>
15536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537req.len : integer
15538req_len : integer (deprecated)
15539 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15540 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15541 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15542 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15543 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15544 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15545 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15546 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015548req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15549 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015550 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15551 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15552 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15553 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555 ACL alternatives :
15556 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15559 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15560 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15561 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15562 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564 ACL alternatives :
15565 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569req.proto_http : boolean
15570req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15571 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15572 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15573 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15574 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15575 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15576 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15577 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579 Example:
15580 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15581 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15582 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015583 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015585req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15586rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15587 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15588 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15589 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15590 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15591 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15592 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15593 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15596 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15597 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15598 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15599 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15600 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602 ACL derivatives :
15603 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605 Example :
15606 listen tse-farm
15607 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15608 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15609 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15610 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15611 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15612 persist rdp-cookie
15613 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15614 # This is only useful makes sense if
15615 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15616 stick-table type string size 204800
15617 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15618 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15619 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15622 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15625rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15626 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15627 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15628 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15629 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631 ACL derivatives :
15632 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015633
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015634req.ssl_alpn : string
15635 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15636 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15637 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15638 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15639 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15640 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015641 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015642
15643 Examples :
15644 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15645 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15646 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015647 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015648 default_backend bk_default
15649
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015650req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15651 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15652 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015653 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15654 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15655 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15656 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15657 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15660req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15661 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15662 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15663 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15664 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15665 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15666 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15667 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015669req.ssl_sni : string
15670req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15671 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15672 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15673 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15674 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15675 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15676 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15677 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15678 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15679 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15680 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15681 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15682 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015684 ACL derivatives :
15685 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687 Examples :
15688 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15689 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15690 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15691 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15692 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015693
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015694req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15695 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15696 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15697 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15698 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15699 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15700 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15701 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15702 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15703 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015705req.ssl_ver : integer
15706req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15707 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15708 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15709 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15710 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15711 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15712 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15713 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015714 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 ACL derivatives :
15718 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015719
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015720res.len : integer
15721 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15722 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15723 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15724 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15725 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15726 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15727 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15728 content inspection.
15729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15731 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015732 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15733 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15734 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15735 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15738 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15739 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15740 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15741 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015743 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015744
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015745res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15746rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15747 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15748 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15749 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15750 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15751 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15752 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15753 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755wait_end : boolean
15756 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15757 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015758 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15760 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015761 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15763 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765 Examples :
15766 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15767 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15768 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015770 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15771 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15772 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15773 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15774 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15775 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15776 tcp-request content reject
15777
15778
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157797.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015780--------------------------------------
15781
15782It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15783This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15784data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15785its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15786HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15787content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15788to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15789more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15790response are indexed.
15791
15792base : string
15793 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15794 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15795 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15796 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15797 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15798 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15799 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15800 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15801
15802 ACL derivatives :
15803 base : exact string match
15804 base_beg : prefix match
15805 base_dir : subdir match
15806 base_dom : domain match
15807 base_end : suffix match
15808 base_len : length match
15809 base_reg : regex match
15810 base_sub : substring match
15811
15812base32 : integer
15813 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15814 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15815 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015816 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15817 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15818 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015819
15820base32+src : binary
15821 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15822 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15823 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15824 per-URL counters.
15825
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015826capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15827 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15828 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15829 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15830
15831capture.req.method : string
15832 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15833 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15834 because it's allocated.
15835
15836capture.req.uri : string
15837 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15838 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15839 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15840 allocated.
15841
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015842capture.req.ver : string
15843 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15844 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15845 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15846
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015847capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15848 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15849 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15850 The first entry is an index of 0.
15851 See also: "capture response header"
15852
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015853capture.res.ver : string
15854 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15855 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15856 persistent flag.
15857
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015858req.body : binary
15859 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15860 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15861 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15862 the first chunk is analyzed.
15863
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015864req.body_param([<name>) : string
15865 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15866 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15867 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15868 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15869 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15870 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15871 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15872 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15873 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15874 given.
15875
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015876req.body_len : integer
15877 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15878 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15879 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15880 "option http-buffer-request".
15881
15882req.body_size : integer
15883 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15884 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15885 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15886 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15887 "option http-buffer-request".
15888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015889req.cook([<name>]) : string
15890cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15891 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15892 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15893 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15894 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15895 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15896 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15897 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15898 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15899
15900 ACL derivatives :
15901 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15902 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15903 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15904 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15905 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15906 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15907 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15908 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15911cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15912 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15913 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15916cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15917 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15918 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15919 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15920 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15923 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15924 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15925 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15926 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015927 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015928 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15929 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15930 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15931 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15934 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15935 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15936 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15937 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015938 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15941 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15942 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15943 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15944 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15945 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15946 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15947 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15948 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015950req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15951 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15952 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15953 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15954 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15957 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15958 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15959 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15960 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15961 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15962 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15963 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15964 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015965 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015966 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015967 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969 ACL derivatives :
15970 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15971 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15972 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15973 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15974 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15975 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15976 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15977 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15978
15979req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15980hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15981 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15982 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15983 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15984 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15985 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15986 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15987 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15988 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15989 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15990
15991req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15992hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15993 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15994 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15995 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15996 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15997 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015998 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015999 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16000 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16001
16002req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16003hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16004 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16005 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16006 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16007 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16008 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16009 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16010 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16011
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016012
16013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016014http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16015 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16016 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16017 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16018 basic auth is supported.
16019
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016020http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16021 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16022 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16023 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16024 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016025 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16026 basic auth is supported.
16027
16028 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016029 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16030 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16031 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16032 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016033
16034http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016035 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16036 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16038 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040method : integer + string
16041 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16042 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16043 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16044 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16045 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16046 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16047 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049 ACL derivatives :
16050 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016052 Example :
16053 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16054 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16055 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057path : string
16058 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16059 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16060 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16061 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16062 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016063 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016064 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066 ACL derivatives :
16067 path : exact string match
16068 path_beg : prefix match
16069 path_dir : subdir match
16070 path_dom : domain match
16071 path_end : suffix match
16072 path_len : length match
16073 path_reg : regex match
16074 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016075
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016076query : string
16077 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16078 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16079 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16080 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016081 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016082 which stops before the question mark.
16083
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016084req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16085 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16086 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16087 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16088 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016090req.ver : string
16091req_ver : string (deprecated)
16092 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16093 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16094 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096 ACL derivatives :
16097 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016099res.comp : boolean
16100 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16101 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16102 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016104res.comp_algo : string
16105 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16106 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16107 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016109res.cook([<name>]) : string
16110scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16111 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16112 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16113 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016115 ACL derivatives :
16116 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16119scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16120 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16121 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16122 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16125scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16126 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16127 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16128 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016130res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16131 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16132 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16133 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16134 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16135 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16136 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16137 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16138 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16139 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016141res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16142 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16143 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16144 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16145 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16146 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16149shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16150 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16151 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16152 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16153 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16154 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16155 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16156 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16157 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159 ACL derivatives :
16160 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16161 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16162 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16163 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16164 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16165 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16166 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16167 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16168
16169res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16170shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16171 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16172 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16173 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16174 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16175 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16178shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16179 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16180 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16181 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16182 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16183 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16184 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016185
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016186res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16187 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16188 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16189 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16190 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16193shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16194 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16195 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16196 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16197 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16198 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16199 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016201res.ver : string
16202resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16203 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16204 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016206 ACL derivatives :
16207 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016209set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16210 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16211 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016212 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016213 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16216 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016218status : integer
16219 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16220 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16221 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016222
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016223unique-id : string
16224 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16225 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16226 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16227 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16228 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16229 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016231url : string
16232 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16233 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16234 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16235 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16236 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16237 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16238 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240 ACL derivatives :
16241 url : exact string match
16242 url_beg : prefix match
16243 url_dir : subdir match
16244 url_dom : domain match
16245 url_end : suffix match
16246 url_len : length match
16247 url_reg : regex match
16248 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016250url_ip : ip
16251 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16252 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16253 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16254 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16255 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16256 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16257 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016259url_port : integer
16260 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16261 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16262 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16263 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016264
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016265urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16266url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016267 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16268 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016269 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16270 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16271 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16272 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16274 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016275 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16276 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016278 ACL derivatives :
16279 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16280 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16281 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16282 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16283 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16284 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16285 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16286 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016287
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016289 Example :
16290 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16291 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16292 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16293 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016294
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016295urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016296 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16297 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16298 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016299
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016300url32 : integer
16301 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16302 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16303 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16304 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16305 is an unsigned integer.
16306
16307url32+src : binary
16308 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16309 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16310 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16311
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200163137.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016314---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016316Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16317every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016318order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016320ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16321---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016322FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016323HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016324HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16325HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016326HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16327HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16328HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16329HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16330LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016331METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016332METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016333METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16334METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16335METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16336METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016337METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016338METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016339RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016340REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016341TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016342WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16343---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016344
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016345
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163468. Logging
16347----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016348
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016349One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16350provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16351very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16352provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16353state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016354to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016355headers.
16356
16357In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16358about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16359send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16360
16361 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16362 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16363 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16364 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16365 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016366 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016367 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016368
16369The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16370allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16371as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16372while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16373real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16374delay.
16375
16376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163778.1. Log levels
16378---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016379
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016380TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016381source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016382HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16383in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16384track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16385syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16386about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016387
16388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163898.2. Log formats
16390----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016391
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016392HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016393and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16394slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16395options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016396
16397 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16398 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16399 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16400 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16401 extents.
16402
16403 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16404 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16405 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16406 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16407 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16408
16409 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16410 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16411 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16412 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16413 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16414
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016415 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16416 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16417 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16418 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16419
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016420 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16421
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016422Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16423specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16424field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16425servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16426always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16427identifier.
16428
16429Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16430 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16431 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16432 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16433 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16434
16435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164368.2.1. Default log format
16437-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016438
16439This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16440as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16441format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16442
16443 Example :
16444 listen www
16445 mode http
16446 log global
16447 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16448
16449 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16450 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16451 (www/HTTP)
16452
16453 Field Format Extract from the example above
16454 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16455 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16456 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16457 4 'to' to
16458 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16459 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16460
16461Detailed fields description :
16462 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16463 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16464 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16465 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16466 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16467 and processed the connection.
16468 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16469
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016470In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16471"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16472connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16473
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016474It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16475will eventually disappear.
16476
16477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164788.2.2. TCP log format
16479---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016480
16481The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16482is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16483information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16484counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16485emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16486environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16487the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16488sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016489specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16490not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16491fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16492marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016493
16494 Example :
16495 frontend fnt
16496 mode tcp
16497 option tcplog
16498 log global
16499 default_backend bck
16500
16501 backend bck
16502 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16503
16504 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16505 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16506 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16507
16508 Field Format Extract from the example above
16509 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16510 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16511 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16512 4 frontend_name fnt
16513 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16514 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16515 7 bytes_read* 212
16516 8 termination_state --
16517 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16518 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16519
16520Detailed fields description :
16521 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016522 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16523 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16524 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016525 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016526 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016527 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016528
16529 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016530 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16531 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16532 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016533
16534 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16535 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16536 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016537 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16538 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16539 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16540 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016541
16542 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16543 and processed the connection.
16544
16545 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16546 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16547 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16548 applications.
16549
16550 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16551 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16552 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16553 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16554 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16555
16556 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16557 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16558 See "Timers" below for more details.
16559
16560 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16561 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16562 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16563 "Timers" below for more details.
16564
16565 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016566 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016567 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16568 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16569 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16570 details.
16571
16572 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16573 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16574 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16575 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16576 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16577
16578 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16579 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16580 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16581 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16582 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16583 for more details.
16584
16585 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016586 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016587 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16588 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16589 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016590 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016591
16592 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16593 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16594 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16595 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16596 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16597 caused by a denial of service attack.
16598
16599 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16600 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16601 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16602 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16603 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16604 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16605 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16606 denial of service attack.
16607
16608 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16609 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16610 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16611 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16612 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16613 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16614 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16615 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16616 be processed than on other servers.
16617
16618 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16619 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16620 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16621 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16622 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16623 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16624 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16625 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16626 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16627 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16628 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16629 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16630 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16631
16632 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16633 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16634 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16635 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16636 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16637 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016638 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016639 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16640
16641 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16642 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16643 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16644 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16645 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16646 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016647 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016648 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16649 occurs.
16650
16651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166528.2.3. HTTP log format
16653----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016654
16655The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16656is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16657the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16658are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16659emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16660generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16661"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16662which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016663frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16664is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016665
16666Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16667slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16668with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16669
16670 Example :
16671 frontend http-in
16672 mode http
16673 option httplog
16674 log global
16675 default_backend bck
16676
16677 backend static
16678 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16679
16680 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16681 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16682 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016683 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016684
16685 Field Format Extract from the example above
16686 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16687 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016688 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689 4 frontend_name http-in
16690 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016691 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016692 7 status_code 200
16693 8 bytes_read* 2750
16694 9 captured_request_cookie -
16695 10 captured_response_cookie -
16696 11 termination_state ----
16697 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16698 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16699 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16700 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16701 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016702
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016703Detailed fields description :
16704 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016705 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16706 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16707 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016708 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016709 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016710 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016711
16712 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016713 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16714 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16715 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016716
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016717 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16718 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016719
16720 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16721 and processed the connection.
16722
16723 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16724 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16725 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16726
16727 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16728 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16729 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16730 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16731 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16732 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16733
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016734 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16735 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16736 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16737 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16738 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16739 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016740 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16741 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016742
16743 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16744 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016745 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016746
16747 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16748 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016749 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16750 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016751
16752 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16753 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16754 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16755 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16756 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016757 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16758 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016759
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016760 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16761 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16762 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16763 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16764 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16765 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16766 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016767 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016768
16769 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16770 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16771 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16772
16773 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16774 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16775 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16776 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16777 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16778 overflowing.
16779
16780 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16781 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16782 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16783 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16784 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16785 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16786 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16787 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16788
16789 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16790 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16791 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16792 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16793 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16794 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16795 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16796 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16797
16798 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16799 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16800 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16801 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16802 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16803 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16804 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16805
16806 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016807 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016808 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16809 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16810 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016811 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016812 system.
16813
16814 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16815 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16816 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16817 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16818 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16819 caused by a denial of service attack.
16820
16821 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16822 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16823 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16824 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16825 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16826 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16827 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16828 denial of service attack.
16829
16830 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16831 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16832 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16833 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16834 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16835 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16836 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16837 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16838 processed than on other servers.
16839
16840 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16841 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16842 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16843 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16844 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16845 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16846 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16847 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16848 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16849 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16850 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16851 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16852 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16853
16854 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16855 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16856 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16857 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16858 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16859 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016860 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016861 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16862
16863 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16864 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16865 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16866 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16867 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16868 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016869 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016870 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16871 occurs.
16872
16873 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16874 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16875 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16876 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16877 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16878 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16879 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16880 cookies" below for more details.
16881
16882 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16883 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16884 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16885 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16886 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16887 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16888 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16889 and cookies" below for more details.
16890
16891 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16892 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16893 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16894 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16895 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16896 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16897 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16898 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16899
16900
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200169018.2.4. Custom log format
16902------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016903
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016904The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016905mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016906
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016907HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016908Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16909separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16910prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16911
16912Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16913variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016914("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016915
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016916If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016917as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016918less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16919the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16920
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016921Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016922In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016923in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016924
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016925Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16926'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16927https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16928such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16929
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016930Flags are :
16931 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016932 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016933 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16934 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016935
16936 Example:
16937
16938 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16939 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16940
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016941 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16942
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016943At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16944
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016945 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16946 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016947
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016948the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016949
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016950 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16951 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16952 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016953
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016954and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16955
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016956 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16957 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016958
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016959Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16960
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016961 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016962 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016963 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16964 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16965 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016966 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16967 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16968 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016969 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016970 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16971 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016972 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016973 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16974 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016975 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016976 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016977 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016978 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016979 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016980 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016981 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016982 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16983 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16984 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16985 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16986 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016987 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016988 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16989 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016990 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016991 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16992 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016993 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16994 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16995 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016996 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016997 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16998 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016999 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017000 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17001 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17002 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017003 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017004 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017005 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17006 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17007 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17008 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017009 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017010 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017011 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017012 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017013 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017014 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017015 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17016 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17017 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017018 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017019 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17020 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017021 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017022 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17023 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017024 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017025 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017026 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017027 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017028
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017029 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017030
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017031
170328.2.5. Error log format
17033-----------------------
17034
17035When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17036protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17037By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17038"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017039will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017040logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17041
17042The format looks like this :
17043
17044 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17045 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17046 Connection error during SSL handshake
17047
17048 Field Format Extract from the example above
17049 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17050 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17051 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17052 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17053 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17054
17055These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17056failures.
17057
17058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170598.3. Advanced logging options
17060-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017061
17062Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17063just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17064options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17065for more information about their usage.
17066
17067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170688.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17069------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017070
17071It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17072haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17073commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17074monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17075ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17076
17077 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17078 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17079 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17080 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17081
17082 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17083 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17084 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017085 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017086 such as other load-balancers.
17087
17088 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17089 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17090 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17091
17092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170938.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17094----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017095
17096The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17097what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17098or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017099"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017100just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17101log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17102after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17103is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17104with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17105with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17106
17107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17109------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017110
17111Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17112for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17113"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17114retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17115raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17116a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17117file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17118you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17119"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17120
17121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171228.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17123--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017124
17125Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17126multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17127them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17128"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17129logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17130error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17131and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17132too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17133useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17134alternative.
17135
17136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171378.4. Timing events
17138------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017139
17140Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17141reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17142the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17143frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017144mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17145addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17146
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017147Timings events in HTTP mode:
17148
17149 first request 2nd request
17150 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17151 t tr t tr ...
17152 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17153 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17154 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17155 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17156 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17157
17158Timings events in TCP mode:
17159
17160 TCP session
17161 |<----------------->|
17162 t t
17163 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17164 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17165 |<------ Tt ------->|
17166
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017167 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017168 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017169 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17170 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17171 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017172 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017173 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17174 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17175 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17176 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017177
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017178 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17179 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17180 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017181 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17182 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17183 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17184 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17185 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17186 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017187
17188 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17189 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17190 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17191 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17192 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17193 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17194 request typed by hand during a test.
17195
17196 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17197 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017198 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017199 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17200 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17201 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17202 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017203
17204 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17205 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17206 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17207 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17208 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17209
17210 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17211 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17212 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17213 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17214 connection never established.
17215
17216 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17217 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17218 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17219 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17220 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17221 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17222 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17223 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17224 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17225 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17226 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17227
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017228 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17229 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17230 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17231 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17232 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17233 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17234
17235 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17236
17237 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17238 "Ta" can never be negative.
17239
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017240 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17241 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017242 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17243 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017244 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017245
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017246 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017247
17248 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017249 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17250 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017251
17252These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17253protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17254that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017255due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17256"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17257that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017258
17259Most common cases :
17260
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017261 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17262 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17263 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17264 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17265 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17266 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17267 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17268 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17269 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17270 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17271 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017272 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017273
17274 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17275 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17276 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17277 of ms on remote networks.
17278
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017279 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17280 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17281 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017282
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017283 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17284 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17285 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17286 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17287 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17288 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17289 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17290 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17291 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017292
17293Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17294
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017295 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017296 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017297 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017298
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017299 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017300 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17301 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17302
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017303 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017304 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17305 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17306 flags.
17307
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017308 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17309 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017310 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17311 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17312 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17313 the client connection was maintained open.
17314
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017315 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017316 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017317 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017318 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17319
17320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173218.5. Session state at disconnection
17322-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017323
17324TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17325"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
173262-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17327each of which has a special meaning :
17328
17329 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17330 session to terminate :
17331
17332 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17333
17334 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17335 server explicitly refused it.
17336
17337 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17338 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17339 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17340 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017341 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017342
17343 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17344 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017345
17346 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17347 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17348 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17349 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17350 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17351
17352 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17353 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17354 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17355 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17356 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17357
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017358 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17359 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17360
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017361 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17362 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17363 backup connections when going up.
17364
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017365 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17366
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017367 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17368 send or receive data.
17369
17370 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17371 send or receive data.
17372
17373 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17374 with nothing left in the buffers.
17375
17376 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17377
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017378 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017379 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17380
17381 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17382 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17383 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17384 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17385 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17386
17387 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17388 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17389
17390 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17391 server (HTTP only).
17392
17393 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17394
17395 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17396 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17397 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17398
17399 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17400 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17401 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17402
17403 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17404
17405 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17406 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17407
17408 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17409 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17410 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17411
17412 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17413 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017414 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17415 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017416
17417 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17418 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17419 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17420 another server.
17421
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017422 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017423 server.
17424
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017425 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17426 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17427 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17428 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17429
17430 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17431 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17432 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17433 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17434
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017435 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17436 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17437 "use-server" rule).
17438
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017439 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17440
17441 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17442 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17443
17444 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17445
17446 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17447 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17448 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17449
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017450 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17451 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017452 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017453 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17454 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17455
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017456 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17457
17458 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17459 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17460
17461 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17462
17463 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17464
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017465The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17466was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017467helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17468starvation, attacks, etc...
17469
17470The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17471alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17472easier finding and understanding.
17473
17474 Flags Reason
17475
17476 -- Normal termination.
17477
17478 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17479 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17480 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17481 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17482
17483 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17484 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17485 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17486 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17487 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17488 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017489
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017490 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17491 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017492 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017493
17494 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17495 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17496 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17497
17498 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17499 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17500 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17501 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17502 the server takes too long to respond.
17503
17504 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17505 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17506 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17507 long a time to respond.
17508
17509 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17510 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17511 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17512 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017513 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17514 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017515
17516 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17517 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17518 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17519 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17520 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017521 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017522 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17523 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17524 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17525 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17526 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17527 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17528 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17529 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017530 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017531 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17532 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17533 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017534
17535 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17536 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017537 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17538 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17539 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17540 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017541
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017542 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17543 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17544
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017545 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017546 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17547 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017548 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017549 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17550 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17551
17552 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17553 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17554 503 or 504 here.
17555
17556 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17557 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17558 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17559 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17560 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17561
17562 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17563 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017564 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017565 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17566 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17567
17568 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17569 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17570 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17571 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17572 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17573 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17574 between haproxy and the server.
17575
17576 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17577 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17578 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17579 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17580 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17581 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17582 solution is to fix the application.
17583
17584 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17585 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17586 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17587 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17588 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17589 external attacks.
17590
17591 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17592 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017593 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017594 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17595 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17596
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017597 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17598 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17599 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017600 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017601 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017602
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017603 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17604 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17605 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17606 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017607 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17608 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17609 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17610 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17611 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017612
17613 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17614 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17615 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17616 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17617
17618 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17619 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17620 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17621 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17622
17623 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17624 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17625 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17626 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17627
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017628The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17629persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17630important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17631re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17632
17633 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17634
17635 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17636 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17637 set on a GET request.
17638
17639 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17640 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017641 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017642 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17643
17644 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17645 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17646 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17647
17648 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17649 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17650 already got a cookie.
17651
17652 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17653 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17654 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17655 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17656 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17657
17658 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17659 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17660 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17661
17662 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17663 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17664 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17665
17666 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17667 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17668
17669 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17670 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17671 then advertised in the response.
17672
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176748.6. Non-printable characters
17675-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017676
17677In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17678consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17679converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17680prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17681being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17682escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17683is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17684'}' when logging headers.
17685
17686Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17687issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17688containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17689
17690Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17691the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17692performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17693
17694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176958.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17696---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017697
17698Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17699achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017700section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017701cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17702the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17703the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017704locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017705not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17706user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17707a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17708wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17709
17710 Examples :
17711 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17712 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17713
17714 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17715 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17716
17717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177188.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17719---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017720
17721Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17722proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17723the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17724server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17725
17726Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17727response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017728section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017729
17730It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017731time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17732appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017733are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17734and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17735follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17736request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17737in the logs.
17738
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017739As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17740frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17741an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17742
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017743 Example :
17744 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17745 listen proxy-out
17746 mode http
17747 option httplog
17748 option logasap
17749 log global
17750 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17751
17752 # log the name of the virtual server
17753 capture request header Host len 20
17754
17755 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17756 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17757
17758 # log the beginning of the referrer
17759 capture request header Referer len 20
17760
17761 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17762 capture response header Server len 20
17763
17764 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17765 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17766
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017767 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017768 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17769
17770 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17771 capture response header Via len 20
17772
17773 # log the URL location during a redirection
17774 capture response header Location len 20
17775
17776 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17777 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17778 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17779 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17780 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17781
17782 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17783 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17784 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17785 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017786 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017787
17788 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17789 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17790 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17791 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17792 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017793 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017794
17795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177968.9. Examples of logs
17797---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017798
17799These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17800them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17801reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17802
17803 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17804 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17805 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17806
17807 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17808 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17809
17810 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17811 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17812 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17813
17814 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17815 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17816
17817 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17818 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17819 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17820
17821 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017822 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017823 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17824 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17825
17826 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17827 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17828 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17829
17830 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17831 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017832 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017833 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17834 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17835 to return the 502 and not the server.
17836
17837 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017838 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017839
17840 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17841 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17842 Nothing was sent to any server.
17843
17844 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17845 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17846
17847 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17848 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017849 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017850 send a 408 return code to the client.
17851
17852 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17853 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17854
17855 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17856 5 seconds ("c----").
17857
17858 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17859 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017860 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017861
17862 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017863 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017864 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17865 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17866 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17867 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17868 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017869
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017870
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178719. Supported filters
17872--------------------
17873
17874Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17875accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17876unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17877
17878See also : "filter"
17879
178809.1. Trace
17881----------
17882
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017883filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017884
17885 Arguments:
17886 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17887 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17888
17889 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17890 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17891 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17892 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17893
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017894 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017895 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17896 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17897 amount of the parsed data.
17898
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017899 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017900
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017901This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17902callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17903information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17904filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17905
17906Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17907tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17908a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17909
17910
179119.2. HTTP compression
17912---------------------
17913
17914filter compression
17915
17916The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17917keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017918when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17919it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17920response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17921line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17922cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17923the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017924
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017925See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017926
17927
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200179289.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17929--------------------------------------------
17930
17931filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17932
17933 Arguments :
17934
17935 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17936 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17937 parsed.
17938
17939 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17940 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17941 part must be placed in its own scope.
17942
17943The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17944external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017945streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017946exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17947also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17948
17949SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17950the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17951
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017952For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017953"doc/SPOE.txt".
17954
17955Important note:
17956 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17957 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17958
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179599.4. Cache
17960----------
17961
17962filter cache <name>
17963
17964 Arguments :
17965
17966 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17967
17968The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17969"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17970cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017971other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17972the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17973mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17974filter other than the compression is used for the same
17975listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17976order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017977
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017978See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017979
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001798010. Cache
17981---------
17982
17983HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17984(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17985RAM.
17986
17987The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017988this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017989
17990If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17991independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17992when we try to allocate a new one.
17993
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017994The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017995
17996It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17997"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17998for more details.
17999
18000When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18001replaced by "<CACHE>".
18002
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001800310.1. Limitation
18004----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018005
18006The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18007
18008- If the response is not a 200
18009- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018010- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018011- If the response is not cacheable
18012
18013- If the request is not a GET
18014- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018015- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018016
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018017Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18018filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18019can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18020example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18021"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018022
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001802310.2. Setup
18024-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018025
18026To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18027the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18028
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001802910.2.1. Cache section
18030---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018031
18032cache <name>
18033 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18034 size of cache is mandatory.
18035
18036total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018037 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018038 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018039
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018040max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018041 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18042 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18043 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018044
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018045max-age <seconds>
18046 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18047 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18048 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18049 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18050 default.
18051
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001805210.2.2. Proxy section
18053---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018054
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018055http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018056 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18057 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18058 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18059 after this one.
18060
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018061http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018062 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18063 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18064 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18065 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18066
18067
18068Example:
18069
18070 backend bck1
18071 mode http
18072
18073 http-request cache-use foobar
18074 http-response cache-store foobar
18075 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18076
18077 cache foobar
18078 total-max-size 4
18079 max-age 240
18080
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018081/*
18082 * Local variables:
18083 * fill-column: 79
18084 * End:
18085 */